merge trunk
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
22
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <stdio.h>
25
26 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
27
28 #include "lisp.h"
29 #include "blockinput.h"
30 #include "syssignal.h"
31
32 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
33 if this is not done before the other system files. */
34 #include "xterm.h"
35 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
36
37 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
38 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
39 #ifndef makedev
40 #include <sys/types.h>
41 #endif /* makedev */
42
43 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
44
45 #include "systime.h"
46
47 #include <fcntl.h>
48 #include <errno.h>
49 #include <sys/stat.h>
50 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
51 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
52
53 #include "charset.h"
54 #include "character.h"
55 #include "coding.h"
56 #include "frame.h"
57 #include "dispextern.h"
58 #include "fontset.h"
59 #include "termhooks.h"
60 #include "termopts.h"
61 #include "termchar.h"
62 #include "emacs-icon.h"
63 #include "disptab.h"
64 #include "buffer.h"
65 #include "window.h"
66 #include "keyboard.h"
67 #include "intervals.h"
68 #include "process.h"
69 #include "atimer.h"
70 #include "keymap.h"
71 #include "font.h"
72 #include "fontset.h"
73 #include "xsettings.h"
74 #include "xgselect.h"
75 #include "sysselect.h"
76
77 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
78 #include <X11/Shell.h>
79 #endif
80
81 #include <unistd.h>
82
83 #ifdef USE_GTK
84 #include "gtkutil.h"
85 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
86 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
87 #endif
88 #endif
89
90 #ifdef USE_LUCID
91 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
92 #endif
93
94 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
95 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
96 #define HACK_EDITRES
97 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
98 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
99
100 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
101
102 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
103 #if defined USE_MOTIF
104 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
105 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
106 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
107
108 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
109 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
110 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
111 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
112 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
113 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
114 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
115 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
116 #ifndef XtNpickTop
117 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
118 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
119 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
120 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
121
122 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
123
124 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
125 #include "widget.h"
126 #ifndef XtNinitialState
127 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
128 #endif
129 #endif
130
131 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
132
133 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
134 #ifdef USE_XIM
135 int use_xim = 1;
136 #else
137 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
138 #endif
139
140 \f
141
142 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
143 start. */
144
145 static int any_help_event_p;
146
147 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
148 static Lisp_Object last_window;
149
150 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
151 use. */
152
153 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
154
155 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
156 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
157 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
158 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
159
160 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
161
162 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
163
164 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
165
166 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
167
168 static struct {
169 struct frame *f;
170 int eventtype;
171 } pending_event_wait;
172
173 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
174 /* The application context for Xt use. */
175 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
176 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
177
178 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
179
180 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
181 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
182
183 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
184 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
185 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
186
187 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
188
189 /* Mouse movement.
190
191 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
192 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
193 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
194 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
195
196 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
197
198 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
199 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
200 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
201 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
202 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
203 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
204 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
205 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
206 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
207 is off. */
208
209 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
210
211 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
212 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
213 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
214
215 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
216
217 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
218 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
219 an ordinary motion.
220
221 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
222 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
223 event. */
224
225 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
226
227 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
228 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
229 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
230 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
231 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
232 it's somewhat accurate. */
233
234 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
235
236 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
237
238 static Time last_user_time;
239
240 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
241 events. */
242
243 static int volatile input_signal_count;
244
245 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
246
247 static int x_noop_count;
248
249 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
250
251 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
252 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
253
254 #ifdef USE_GTK
255 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
256 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
257
258 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
259 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
260 #endif
261
262 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
263 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
264
265 enum xembed_info
266 {
267 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
268 };
269
270 enum xembed_message
271 {
272 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
273 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
274 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
275 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
276 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
277 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
278 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
279 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
280
281 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
282 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
283 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
284 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
285 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
286 };
287
288 /* Used in x_flush. */
289
290 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
291 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
292 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
293 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
294 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
295 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
296
297 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
298 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
299 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
300 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
301 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
302 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
303 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
304 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
305 static _Noreturn void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int);
306 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
307 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
308 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
309 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
310 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
311 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
312 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
313 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
314 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
315 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
316 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
317 enum text_cursor_kinds);
318
319 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
320 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
321 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
322 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
323 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
324 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
325 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
326 enum scroll_bar_part *,
327 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
328 Time *);
329 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
330 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
331 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
332 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
333 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
334 int *, struct input_event *);
335 #ifdef USE_GTK
336 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
337 #endif
338 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
339 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
340 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
341 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
342 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
343 static void x_initialize (void);
344
345
346 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
347
348 static void
349 x_flush (struct frame *f)
350 {
351 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
352 connection may be broken. */
353 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
354 return;
355
356 BLOCK_INPUT;
357 if (f == NULL)
358 {
359 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
360 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
361 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
362 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
363 }
364 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
365 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
366 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
367 }
368
369
370 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
371 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
372 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
373 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
374 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
375 performance. */
376
377 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
378
379 \f
380 /***********************************************************************
381 Debugging
382 ***********************************************************************/
383
384 #if 0
385
386 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
387 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
388
389 struct record
390 {
391 char *locus;
392 int type;
393 };
394
395 struct record event_record[100];
396
397 int event_record_index;
398
399 void
400 record_event (char *locus, int type)
401 {
402 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
403 event_record_index = 0;
404
405 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
406 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
407 event_record_index++;
408 }
409
410 #endif /* 0 */
411
412
413 \f
414 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
415
416 struct x_display_info *
417 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
418 {
419 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
420
421 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
422 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
423 return dpyinfo;
424
425 return 0;
426 }
427
428 static Window
429 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
430 {
431 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
432 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
433 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
434
435 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
436 {
437 Window root;
438 Window *children;
439 unsigned int nchildren;
440
441 win = wi;
442 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
443 XFree (children);
444 }
445
446 return win;
447 }
448
449 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
450
451 void
452 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
453 {
454 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
455 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
456 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
457 double alpha = 1.0;
458 double alpha_min = 1.0;
459 unsigned long opac;
460 Window parent;
461
462 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
463 alpha = f->alpha[0];
464 else
465 alpha = f->alpha[1];
466
467 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
468 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
469 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
470 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
471
472 if (alpha < 0.0)
473 return;
474 else if (alpha > 1.0)
475 alpha = 1.0;
476 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
477 alpha = alpha_min;
478
479 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
480
481 x_catch_errors (dpy);
482
483 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
484 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
485 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
486 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
487
488 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
489 if (parent != None)
490 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
491 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
492 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
493
494 /* return unless necessary */
495 {
496 unsigned char *data;
497 Atom actual;
498 int rc, format;
499 unsigned long n, left;
500
501 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
502 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
503 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
504 &data);
505
506 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
507 {
508 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
509 XFree (data);
510 if (value == opac)
511 {
512 x_uncatch_errors ();
513 return;
514 }
515 }
516 }
517
518 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
519 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
520 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
521 x_uncatch_errors ();
522 }
523
524 int
525 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
526 {
527 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
528 }
529
530 int
531 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
532 {
533 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
534 }
535
536 \f
537 /***********************************************************************
538 Starting and ending an update
539 ***********************************************************************/
540
541 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
542 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
543 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
544 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
545 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
546
547 static void
548 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
549 {
550 /* Nothing to do. */
551 }
552
553
554 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
555 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
556 position of W. */
557
558 static void
559 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
560 {
561 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
562 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
563
564 updated_window = w;
565 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
566
567 BLOCK_INPUT;
568
569 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
570 {
571 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
572 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
573
574 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
575 highlighting. */
576 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
577 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
578 }
579
580 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
581 }
582
583
584 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
585
586 static void
587 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
588 {
589 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
590 struct face *face;
591
592 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
593 if (face)
594 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
595 face->foreground);
596
597 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
598 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
599 }
600
601 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
602
603 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
604 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
605
606 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
607 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
608 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
609
610 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
611 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
612 here. */
613
614 static void
615 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
616 {
617 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
618
619 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
620 {
621 BLOCK_INPUT;
622
623 if (cursor_on_p)
624 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
625 output_cursor.vpos,
626 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
627
628 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
629 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
630
631 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
632 }
633
634 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
635 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
636 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
637 {
638 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
639 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
640 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
641 }
642
643 updated_window = NULL;
644 }
645
646
647 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
648 update_end. */
649
650 static void
651 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
652 {
653 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
654 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
655
656 #ifndef XFlush
657 BLOCK_INPUT;
658 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
659 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
660 #endif
661 }
662
663
664 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
665 complete update has been performed. The global variable
666 updated_window is not available here. */
667
668 static void
669 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
670 {
671 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
672 {
673 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
674
675 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
676 || f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
677 {
678 BLOCK_INPUT;
679 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
680 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
681 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
682 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
683 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
684 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
685 }
686 }
687 }
688
689
690 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
691 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
692 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
693 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
694 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
695 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
696
697 static void
698 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
699 {
700 struct window *w = updated_window;
701 struct frame *f;
702 int width, height;
703
704 eassert (w);
705
706 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
707 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
708
709 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
710 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
711 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
712 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
713 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
714 overhead is very small. */
715 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
716 && desired_row->full_width_p
717 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
718 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
719 width != 0)
720 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
721 height > 0))
722 {
723 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
724
725 BLOCK_INPUT;
726 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
727 0, y, width, height, False);
728 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
729 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
730 y, width, height, False);
731 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
732 }
733 }
734
735 static void
736 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
737 {
738 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
739 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
740 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
741 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
742 struct face *face = p->face;
743
744 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
745 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
746
747 if (!p->overlay_p)
748 {
749 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
750
751 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
752 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
753 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
754 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
755 if (face->stipple)
756 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
757 else
758 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
759
760 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
761 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
762 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
763 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
764 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
765 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
766 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
767 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
768 {
769 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
770
771 if (sb_width > 0)
772 {
773 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
774 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
775 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
776
777 if (bx < 0)
778 {
779 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
780 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
781 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
782 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
783 bx = bar_area_x;
784 if (bx >= 0)
785 {
786 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
787
788 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
789 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
790 row->y));
791 ny = row->visible_height;
792 }
793 }
794 else
795 {
796 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
797 {
798 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
799 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
800 }
801 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
802 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
803 }
804 }
805 }
806 #endif
807 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
808 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
809
810 if (!face->stipple)
811 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
812 }
813
814 if (p->which)
815 {
816 char *bits;
817 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
818 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
819 XGCValues gcv;
820
821 if (p->wd > 8)
822 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
823 else
824 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
825
826 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
827 by the server. */
828 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
829 (p->cursor_p
830 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
831 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
832 : face->foreground),
833 face->background, depth);
834
835 if (p->overlay_p)
836 {
837 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
838 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
839 bits, p->wd, p->h,
840 1, 0, 1);
841 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
842 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
843 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
844 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
845 }
846
847 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
848 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
849 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
850
851 if (p->overlay_p)
852 {
853 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
854 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
855 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
856 }
857 }
858
859 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
860 }
861
862 \f
863
864 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
865 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
866 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
867 rarely happens). */
868
869 static void
870 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
871 {
872 }
873
874 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
875 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
876
877 static void
878 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
879 {
880 }
881
882 \f
883 /***********************************************************************
884 Glyph display
885 ***********************************************************************/
886
887
888
889 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
890 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
891 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
892 int);
893 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
894 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
895 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
896 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
897 static _Noreturn void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int);
898 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
899 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
900 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
901 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
902 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
903 unsigned long *, double, int);
904 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
905 double, int, unsigned long);
906 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
907 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
908 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
909 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
910 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
911 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
912 int, int, int);
913 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
914 int, int, int, int, int, int,
915 XRectangle *);
916 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
917 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
918 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
919
920 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
921 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
922 #endif
923
924
925 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
926 face. */
927
928 static void
929 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
930 {
931 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
932 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
933 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
934 && !s->cmp)
935 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
936 else
937 {
938 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
939 XGCValues xgcv;
940 unsigned long mask;
941
942 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
943 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
944
945 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
946 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
947 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
948 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
949 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
950 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
951 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
952
953 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
954 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
955 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
956 {
957 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
958 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
959 }
960
961 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
962 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
963 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
964
965 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
966 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
967 mask, &xgcv);
968 else
969 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
970 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
971
972 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
973 }
974 }
975
976
977 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
978
979 static void
980 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
981 {
982 int face_id;
983 struct face *face;
984
985 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
986 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
987 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
988 if (face == NULL)
989 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
990
991 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
992 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
993 else
994 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
995 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
996 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
997
998 if (s->font == s->face->font)
999 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1000 else
1001 {
1002 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1003 except for FONT. */
1004 XGCValues xgcv;
1005 unsigned long mask;
1006
1007 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1008 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1009 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1010 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1011
1012 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1013 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1014 mask, &xgcv);
1015 else
1016 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1017 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1018
1019 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1020
1021 }
1022 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1023 }
1024
1025
1026 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1027 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1028 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1029
1030 static inline void
1031 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1032 {
1033 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1034 }
1035
1036
1037 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1038 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1039 pattern. */
1040
1041 static inline void
1042 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1043 {
1044 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1045
1046 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1047 {
1048 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1049 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1050 }
1051 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1052 {
1053 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1054 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1055 }
1056 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1057 {
1058 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1059 s->stippled_p = 0;
1060 }
1061 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1062 {
1063 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1064 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1065 }
1066 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1067 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1068 {
1069 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1070 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1071 }
1072 else
1073 {
1074 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1075 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1076 }
1077
1078 /* GC must have been set. */
1079 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1080 }
1081
1082
1083 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1084 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1085
1086 static inline void
1087 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1088 {
1089 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1090 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1091
1092 if (n > 0)
1093 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1094 s->num_clips = n;
1095 }
1096
1097
1098 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1099 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1100 the area of SRC. */
1101
1102 static void
1103 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1104 {
1105 XRectangle r;
1106
1107 r.x = src->x;
1108 r.width = src->width;
1109 r.y = src->y;
1110 r.height = src->height;
1111 dst->clip[0] = r;
1112 dst->num_clips = 1;
1113 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1114 }
1115
1116
1117 /* RIF:
1118 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1119
1120 static void
1121 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1122 {
1123 if (s->cmp == NULL
1124 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1125 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1126 {
1127 struct font_metrics metrics;
1128
1129 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1130 {
1131 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1132 struct font *font = s->font;
1133 int i;
1134
1135 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1136 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1137 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1138 }
1139 else
1140 {
1141 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1142
1143 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1144 }
1145 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1146 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1147 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1148 }
1149 else if (s->cmp)
1150 {
1151 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1152 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1153 }
1154 }
1155
1156
1157 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1158
1159 static inline void
1160 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1161 {
1162 XGCValues xgcv;
1163 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1164 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1165 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1166 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1167 }
1168
1169
1170 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1171 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1172 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1173 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1174 contains the first component of a composition. */
1175
1176 static void
1177 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1178 {
1179 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1180 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1181 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1182 {
1183 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1184
1185 if (s->stippled_p)
1186 {
1187 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1188 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1189 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1190 s->y + box_line_width,
1191 s->background_width,
1192 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1193 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1194 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1195 }
1196 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1197 || s->font_not_found_p
1198 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1199 || force_p)
1200 {
1201 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1202 s->background_width,
1203 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1204 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1205 }
1206 }
1207 }
1208
1209
1210 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1211
1212 static void
1213 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1214 {
1215 int i, x;
1216
1217 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1218 of S to the right of that box line. */
1219 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1220 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1221 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1222 else
1223 x = s->x;
1224
1225 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1226 loaded. */
1227 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1228 {
1229 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1230 {
1231 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1232 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1233 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1234 s->height - 1);
1235 x += g->pixel_width;
1236 }
1237 }
1238 else
1239 {
1240 struct font *font = s->font;
1241 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1242 int y;
1243
1244 if (font->vertical_centering)
1245 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1246
1247 y = s->ybase - boff;
1248 if (s->for_overlaps
1249 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1250 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1251 else
1252 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1253 if (s->face->overstrike)
1254 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1255 }
1256 }
1257
1258 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1259
1260 static void
1261 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1262 {
1263 int i, j, x;
1264 struct font *font = s->font;
1265
1266 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1267 of S to the right of that box line. */
1268 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1269 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1270 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1271 else
1272 x = s->x;
1273
1274 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1275 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1276 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1277 this composition. */
1278
1279 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1280 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1281 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1282 {
1283 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1284 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1285 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1286 }
1287 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1288 {
1289 int y = s->ybase;
1290
1291 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1292 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1293 space on the left or right. */
1294 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1295 {
1296 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1297 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1298
1299 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1300 if (s->face->overstrike)
1301 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1302 }
1303 }
1304 else
1305 {
1306 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1307 Lisp_Object glyph;
1308 int y = s->ybase;
1309 int width = 0;
1310
1311 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1312 {
1313 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1314 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1315 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1316 else
1317 {
1318 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1319
1320 if (j < i)
1321 {
1322 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1323 if (s->face->overstrike)
1324 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1325 x += width;
1326 }
1327 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1328 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1329 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1330 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1331 if (s->face->overstrike)
1332 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1333 x += wadjust;
1334 j = i + 1;
1335 width = 0;
1336 }
1337 }
1338 if (j < i)
1339 {
1340 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1341 if (s->face->overstrike)
1342 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1343 }
1344 }
1345 }
1346
1347
1348 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1349
1350 static void
1351 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1352 {
1353 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1354 XChar2b char2b[8];
1355 int x, i, j;
1356
1357 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1358 of S to the right of that box line. */
1359 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1360 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1361 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1362 else
1363 x = s->x;
1364
1365 s->char2b = char2b;
1366
1367 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1368 {
1369 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1370 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1371
1372 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1373 {
1374 if (len > 0
1375 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1376 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1377 >= 1))
1378 {
1379 Lisp_Object acronym
1380 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1381 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1382 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1383 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1384 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1385 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1386 }
1387 }
1388 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1389 {
1390 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1391 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1392 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1393 str = buf;
1394 }
1395
1396 if (str)
1397 {
1398 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1399 unsigned code;
1400
1401 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1402 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1403 {
1404 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1405 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1406 }
1407 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1408 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1409 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1410 0);
1411 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1412 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1413 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1414 0);
1415 }
1416 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1417 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1418 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1419 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1420 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1421 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1422 }
1423 }
1424
1425 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1426
1427 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1428 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1429 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1430 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1431
1432 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1433
1434 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1435 cannot be determined. */
1436
1437 static struct frame *
1438 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1439 {
1440 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1441 Lisp_Object tail;
1442 struct frame *f;
1443
1444 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1445
1446 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1447 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1448 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1449 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1450 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1451 widget = XtParent (widget);
1452
1453 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1454 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1455 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1456 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1457 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1458 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1459 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1460 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1461 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1462 return f;
1463
1464 emacs_abort ();
1465 }
1466
1467 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1468 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1469 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1470 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1471 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1472 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1473
1474 int
1475 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1476 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1477 {
1478 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1479 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1480 }
1481
1482 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
1483
1484
1485 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1486 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1487
1488 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1489 {
1490 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1491 sizeof (Screen *)},
1492 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1493 sizeof (Colormap)}
1494 };
1495
1496
1497 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1498 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1499
1500 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1501
1502
1503 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1504
1505 DPY is the display we are working on.
1506
1507 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1508 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1509 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1510 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1511
1512 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1513 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1514
1515 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1516 we allocated the color or not.
1517
1518 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1519
1520 static Boolean
1521 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1522 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1523 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1524 {
1525 Screen *screen;
1526 Colormap cmap;
1527 Pixel pixel;
1528 String color_name;
1529 XColor color;
1530
1531 if (*nargs != 2)
1532 {
1533 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1534 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1535 "XtToolkitError",
1536 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1537 return False;
1538 }
1539
1540 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1541 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1542 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1543
1544 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1545 {
1546 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1547 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1548 }
1549 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1550 {
1551 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1552 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1553 }
1554 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1555 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1556 {
1557 pixel = color.pixel;
1558 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1559 }
1560 else
1561 {
1562 String params[1];
1563 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1564
1565 params[0] = color_name;
1566 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1567 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1568 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1569 params, &nparams);
1570 return False;
1571 }
1572
1573 if (to->addr != NULL)
1574 {
1575 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1576 {
1577 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1578 return False;
1579 }
1580
1581 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1582 }
1583 else
1584 {
1585 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1586 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1587 }
1588
1589 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1590 return True;
1591 }
1592
1593
1594 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1595 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1596 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1597
1598 APP is the application context in which we work.
1599
1600 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1601 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1602 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1603
1604 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1605
1606 static void
1607 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1608 Cardinal *nargs)
1609 {
1610 if (*nargs != 2)
1611 {
1612 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1613 "XtToolkitError",
1614 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1615 NULL, NULL);
1616 }
1617 else if (closure != NULL)
1618 {
1619 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1620 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1621 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1622 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1623 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1624 }
1625 }
1626
1627
1628 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1629
1630
1631 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1632 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1633 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1634 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1635
1636 static const XColor *
1637 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1638 {
1639 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1640
1641 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1642 {
1643 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1644 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1645 int i;
1646
1647 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1648 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1649 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1650
1651 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1652 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1653
1654 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1655 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1656 }
1657
1658 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1659 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1660 }
1661
1662
1663 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1664 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1665
1666 void
1667 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1668 {
1669 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1670
1671 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1672 {
1673 int i;
1674 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1675 {
1676 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1677 eassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1678 eassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1679 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1680 }
1681 }
1682 else
1683 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1684 }
1685
1686
1687 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1688 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1689
1690 void
1691 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1692 {
1693 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1694 }
1695
1696
1697 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1698 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1699 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1700 allocated. */
1701
1702 static int
1703 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1704 {
1705 int rc;
1706
1707 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1708 if (rc == 0)
1709 {
1710 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1711 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1712 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1713 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1714 int nearest, i;
1715 int max_color_delta = 255;
1716 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1717 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1718 int ncells;
1719 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1720
1721 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1722 {
1723 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1724 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1725 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1726 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1727
1728 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1729 {
1730 nearest = i;
1731 nearest_delta = delta;
1732 }
1733 }
1734
1735 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1736 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1737 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1738 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1739 }
1740 else
1741 {
1742 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1743 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1744 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1745 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1746 XColor *cached_color;
1747
1748 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1749 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1750 (cached_color->red != color->red
1751 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1752 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1753 {
1754 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1755 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1756 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1757 }
1758 }
1759
1760 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1761 if (rc)
1762 register_color (color->pixel);
1763 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1764
1765 return rc;
1766 }
1767
1768
1769 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1770 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1771 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1772 allocated. */
1773
1774 int
1775 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1776 {
1777 gamma_correct (f, color);
1778 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1779 }
1780
1781
1782 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1783 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1784 get color reference counts right. */
1785
1786 unsigned long
1787 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1788 {
1789 XColor color;
1790
1791 color.pixel = pixel;
1792 BLOCK_INPUT;
1793 x_query_color (f, &color);
1794 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1795 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1796 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1797 register_color (pixel);
1798 #endif
1799 return color.pixel;
1800 }
1801
1802
1803 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1804 boosted.
1805
1806 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1807 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1808 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1809 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1810 use an additional additive factor.
1811
1812 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1813 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1814 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1815
1816
1817 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1818 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1819 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1820 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1821 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1822 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1823
1824 static int
1825 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1826 {
1827 XColor color, new;
1828 long bright;
1829 int success_p;
1830
1831 /* Get RGB color values. */
1832 color.pixel = *pixel;
1833 x_query_color (f, &color);
1834
1835 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1836 eassert (factor >= 0);
1837 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1838 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1839 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1840
1841 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1842 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1843
1844 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1845 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1846 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1847 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1848 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1849 {
1850 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1851 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1852 /* The additive adjustment. */
1853 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1854
1855 if (factor < 1)
1856 {
1857 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1858 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1859 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1860 }
1861 else
1862 {
1863 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1864 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1865 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1866 }
1867 }
1868
1869 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1870 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1871 if (success_p)
1872 {
1873 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1874 {
1875 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1876 delta to the RGB values. */
1877 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1878
1879 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1880 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1881 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1882 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1883 }
1884 else
1885 success_p = 1;
1886 *pixel = new.pixel;
1887 }
1888
1889 return success_p;
1890 }
1891
1892
1893 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1894 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1895 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1896 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1897 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1898 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1899
1900 static void
1901 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1902 {
1903 XGCValues xgcv;
1904 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1905 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1906 unsigned long pixel;
1907 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1908 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1909 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1910 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1911
1912 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1913 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1914
1915 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1916 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1917 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1918 if (relief->gc
1919 && relief->allocated_p)
1920 {
1921 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1922 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1923 }
1924
1925 /* Allocate new color. */
1926 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1927 pixel = background;
1928 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1929 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1930 {
1931 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1932 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1933 }
1934
1935 if (relief->gc == 0)
1936 {
1937 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1938 mask |= GCStipple;
1939 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1940 }
1941 else
1942 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1943 }
1944
1945
1946 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1947
1948 static void
1949 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1950 {
1951 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1952 unsigned long color;
1953
1954 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1955 color = s->face->box_color;
1956 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1957 && s->img->pixmap
1958 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1959 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1960 else
1961 {
1962 XGCValues xgcv;
1963
1964 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1965 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1966 color = xgcv.background;
1967 }
1968
1969 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1970 || color != di->relief_background)
1971 {
1972 di->relief_background = color;
1973 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1974 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1975 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1976 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1977 }
1978 }
1979
1980
1981 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1982 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1983 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1984 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1985 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1986 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1987 when drawing. */
1988
1989 static void
1990 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
1991 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1992 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
1993 XRectangle *clip_rect)
1994 {
1995 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1996 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1997 int i;
1998 GC gc;
1999
2000 if (raised_p)
2001 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2002 else
2003 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2004 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2005
2006 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
2007 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
2008 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
2009 corner pixels. */
2010
2011 /* Top. */
2012 if (top_p)
2013 {
2014 if (width == 1)
2015 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2016 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2017 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2018
2019 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2020 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2021 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2022 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2023 }
2024
2025 /* Left. */
2026 if (left_p)
2027 {
2028 if (width == 1)
2029 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2030
2031 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2032 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2033
2034 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2035 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2036 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2037 }
2038
2039 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2040 if (raised_p)
2041 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2042 else
2043 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2044 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2045
2046 if (width > 1)
2047 {
2048 /* Outermost top line. */
2049 if (top_p)
2050 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2051 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2052 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2053
2054 /* Outermost left line. */
2055 if (left_p)
2056 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2057 }
2058
2059 /* Bottom. */
2060 if (bot_p)
2061 {
2062 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2063 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2064 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2065 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2066 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2067 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2068 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2069 }
2070
2071 /* Right. */
2072 if (right_p)
2073 {
2074 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2075 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2076 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2077 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2078 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2079 }
2080
2081 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2082 }
2083
2084
2085 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2086 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2087 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2088 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2089 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2090 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2091
2092 static void
2093 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2094 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2095 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2096 {
2097 XGCValues xgcv;
2098
2099 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2100 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2101 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2102
2103 /* Top. */
2104 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2105 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2106
2107 /* Left. */
2108 if (left_p)
2109 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2110 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2111
2112 /* Bottom. */
2113 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2114 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2115
2116 /* Right. */
2117 if (right_p)
2118 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2119 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2120
2121 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2122 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2123 }
2124
2125
2126 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2127
2128 static void
2129 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2130 {
2131 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2132 int left_p, right_p;
2133 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2134 XRectangle clip_rect;
2135
2136 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2137 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2138 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2139
2140 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2141 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2142 ? s->first_glyph
2143 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2144
2145 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2146 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2147 left_x = s->x;
2148 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2149 ? last_x - 1
2150 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2151 top_y = s->y;
2152 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2153
2154 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2155 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2156 && (s->prev == NULL
2157 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2158 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2159 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2160 && (s->next == NULL
2161 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2162
2163 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2164
2165 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2166 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2167 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2168 else
2169 {
2170 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2171 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2172 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2173 }
2174 }
2175
2176
2177 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2178
2179 static void
2180 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2181 {
2182 int x = s->x;
2183 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2184
2185 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2186 right of that line. */
2187 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2188 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2189 && s->slice.x == 0)
2190 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2191
2192 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2193 by that margin. */
2194 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2195 x += s->img->hmargin;
2196 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2197 y += s->img->vmargin;
2198
2199 if (s->img->pixmap)
2200 {
2201 if (s->img->mask)
2202 {
2203 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2204 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2205 trust on the shape extension to be available
2206 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2207 manually. */
2208 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2209 | GCFunction);
2210 XGCValues xgcv;
2211 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2212
2213 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2214 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2215 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2216 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2217 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2218
2219 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2220 image_rect.x = x;
2221 image_rect.y = y;
2222 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2223 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2224 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2225 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2226 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2227 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2228 }
2229 else
2230 {
2231 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2232
2233 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2234 image_rect.x = x;
2235 image_rect.y = y;
2236 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2237 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2238 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2239 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2240 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2241 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2242
2243 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2244 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2245 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2246 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2247 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2248 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2249 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2250 {
2251 int relief = s->img->relief;
2252 if (relief < 0) relief = -relief;
2253 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2254 x - relief, y - relief,
2255 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2256 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2257 }
2258 }
2259 }
2260 else
2261 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2262 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2263 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2264 }
2265
2266
2267 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2268
2269 static void
2270 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2271 {
2272 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2273 int extra_x, extra_y;
2274 XRectangle r;
2275 int x = s->x;
2276 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2277
2278 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2279 right of that line. */
2280 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2281 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2282 && s->slice.x == 0)
2283 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2284
2285 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2286 by that margin. */
2287 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2288 x += s->img->hmargin;
2289 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2290 y += s->img->vmargin;
2291
2292 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2293 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2294 {
2295 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2296 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2297 }
2298 else
2299 {
2300 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2301 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2302 }
2303
2304 extra_x = extra_y = 0;
2305 if (s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID)
2306 {
2307 if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin)
2308 && INTEGERP (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2309 && INTEGERP (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)))
2310 {
2311 extra_x = XINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2312 extra_y = XINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2313 }
2314 else if (INTEGERP (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2315 extra_x = extra_y = XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
2316 }
2317
2318 x0 = x - thick - extra_x;
2319 y0 = y - thick - extra_y;
2320 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra_x;
2321 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra_y;
2322
2323 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2324 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2325 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2326 s->slice.y == 0,
2327 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2328 s->slice.x == 0,
2329 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2330 &r);
2331 }
2332
2333
2334 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2335
2336 static void
2337 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2338 {
2339 int x = 0;
2340 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2341
2342 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2343 right of that line. */
2344 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2345 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2346 && s->slice.x == 0)
2347 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2348
2349 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2350 by that margin. */
2351 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2352 x += s->img->hmargin;
2353 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2354 y += s->img->vmargin;
2355
2356 if (s->img->pixmap)
2357 {
2358 if (s->img->mask)
2359 {
2360 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2361 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2362 trust on the shape extension to be available
2363 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2364 manually. */
2365 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2366 | GCFunction);
2367 XGCValues xgcv;
2368
2369 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2370 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2371 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2372 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2373 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2374
2375 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2376 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2377 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2378 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2379 }
2380 else
2381 {
2382 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2383 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2384 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2385
2386 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2387 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2388 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2389 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2390 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2391 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2392 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2393 {
2394 int r = s->img->relief;
2395 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2396 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2397 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2398 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2399 }
2400 }
2401 }
2402 else
2403 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2404 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2405 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2406 }
2407
2408
2409 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2410 give the rectangle to draw. */
2411
2412 static void
2413 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2414 {
2415 if (s->stippled_p)
2416 {
2417 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2418 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2419 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2420 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2421 }
2422 else
2423 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2424 }
2425
2426
2427 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2428
2429 s->y
2430 s->x +-------------------------
2431 | s->face->box
2432 |
2433 | +-------------------------
2434 | | s->img->margin
2435 | |
2436 | | +-------------------
2437 | | | the image
2438
2439 */
2440
2441 static void
2442 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2443 {
2444 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2445 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2446 int height;
2447 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2448
2449 height = s->height;
2450 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2451 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2452 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2453 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2454
2455 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2456 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2457 flickering. */
2458 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2459 if (height > s->slice.height
2460 || s->img->hmargin
2461 || s->img->vmargin
2462 || s->img->mask
2463 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2464 || s->width != s->background_width)
2465 {
2466 if (s->img->mask)
2467 {
2468 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2469 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2470 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2471 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2472 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2473
2474 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2475 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2476 s->background_width,
2477 s->height, depth);
2478
2479 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2480 pixmap. */
2481 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2482
2483 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2484 if (s->stippled_p)
2485 {
2486 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2487 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2488 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2489 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2490 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2491 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2492 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2493 }
2494 else
2495 {
2496 XGCValues xgcv;
2497 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2498 &xgcv);
2499 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2500 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2501 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2502 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2503 }
2504 }
2505 else
2506 {
2507 int x = s->x;
2508 int y = s->y;
2509
2510 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2511 && s->slice.x == 0)
2512 x += box_line_hwidth;
2513
2514 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2515 y += box_line_vwidth;
2516
2517 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2518 }
2519
2520 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2521 }
2522
2523 /* Draw the foreground. */
2524 if (pixmap != None)
2525 {
2526 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2527 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2528 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2529 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2530 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2531 }
2532 else
2533 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2534
2535 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2536 if (s->img->relief
2537 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2538 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2539 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2540 }
2541
2542
2543 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2544
2545 static void
2546 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2547 {
2548 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2549
2550 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2551 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2552 {
2553 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2554 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2555 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2556 int x = s->x;
2557
2558 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2559 {
2560 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2561
2562 if (x < left_x)
2563 {
2564 background_width -= left_x - x;
2565 x = left_x;
2566 }
2567 }
2568 else
2569 {
2570 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2571 stretch glyph. */
2572 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2573
2574 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2575 background_width -= x - right_x;
2576 x += background_width;
2577 }
2578 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2579 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2580 x -= width;
2581
2582 /* Draw cursor. */
2583 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2584
2585 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2586 if (width < background_width)
2587 {
2588 int y = s->y;
2589 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2590 XRectangle r;
2591 GC gc;
2592
2593 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2594 x += width;
2595 else
2596 x = s->x;
2597 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2598 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2599 {
2600 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2601 gc = s->gc;
2602 }
2603 else
2604 gc = s->face->gc;
2605
2606 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2607 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2608
2609 if (s->face->stipple)
2610 {
2611 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2612 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2613 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2614 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2615 }
2616 else
2617 {
2618 XGCValues xgcv;
2619 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2620 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2621 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2622 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2623 }
2624 }
2625 }
2626 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2627 {
2628 int background_width = s->background_width;
2629 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2630
2631 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2632 except for header line and mode line. */
2633 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2634 {
2635 background_width -= left_x - x;
2636 x = left_x;
2637 }
2638 if (background_width > 0)
2639 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2640 }
2641
2642 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2643 }
2644
2645 /*
2646 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2647
2648 x0 wave_length = 2
2649 --
2650 y0 * * * * *
2651 |* * * * * * * * *
2652 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2653
2654 */
2655
2656 static void
2657 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string *s)
2658 {
2659 int wave_height = 2, wave_length = 3;
2660 int dx, dy, x0, y0, width, x1, y1, x2, y2, odd, xmax;
2661 XRectangle wave_clip, string_clip, final_clip;
2662
2663 dx = wave_length;
2664 dy = wave_height - 1;
2665 x0 = s->x;
2666 y0 = s->ybase + 1;
2667 width = s->width;
2668 xmax = x0 + width;
2669
2670 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2671
2672 wave_clip = (XRectangle){ x0, y0, width, wave_height };
2673 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &string_clip);
2674
2675 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip, &string_clip, &final_clip))
2676 return;
2677
2678 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &final_clip, 1, Unsorted);
2679
2680 /* Draw the waves */
2681
2682 x1 = x0 - (x0 % dx);
2683 x2 = x1 + dx;
2684 odd = (x1/dx) % 2;
2685 y1 = y2 = y0;
2686
2687 if (odd)
2688 y1 += dy;
2689 else
2690 y2 += dy;
2691
2692 if (INT_MAX - dx < xmax)
2693 emacs_abort ();
2694
2695 while (x1 <= xmax)
2696 {
2697 XDrawLine (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x1, y1, x2, y2);
2698 x1 = x2, y1 = y2;
2699 x2 += dx, y2 = y0 + odd*dy;
2700 odd = !odd;
2701 }
2702
2703 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2704 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, s->clip, s->num_clips, Unsorted);
2705 }
2706
2707
2708 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2709
2710 static void
2711 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2712 {
2713 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2714
2715 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2716 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2717 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2718 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2719 {
2720 int width;
2721 struct glyph_string *next;
2722
2723 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2724 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2725 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2726 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2727 {
2728 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2729 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2730 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2731 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2732 else
2733 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2734 next->num_clips = 0;
2735 }
2736 }
2737
2738 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2739 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2740
2741 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2742 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2743 if (!s->for_overlaps
2744 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2745 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2746 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2747
2748 {
2749 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2750 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2751 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2752 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2753 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2754 }
2755 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2756 && !s->clip_tail
2757 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2758 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2759 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2760 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2761 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2762 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2763 else
2764 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2765
2766 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2767 {
2768 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2769 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2770 break;
2771
2772 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2773 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2774 break;
2775
2776 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2777 if (s->for_overlaps)
2778 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2779 else
2780 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2781 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2782 break;
2783
2784 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2785 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2786 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2787 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2788 else
2789 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2790 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2791 break;
2792
2793 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2794 if (s->for_overlaps)
2795 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2796 else
2797 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2798 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2799 break;
2800
2801 default:
2802 emacs_abort ();
2803 }
2804
2805 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2806 {
2807 /* Draw underline. */
2808 if (s->face->underline_p)
2809 {
2810 if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_WAVE)
2811 {
2812 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2813 x_draw_underwave (s);
2814 else
2815 {
2816 XGCValues xgcv;
2817 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2818 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2819 x_draw_underwave (s);
2820 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2821 }
2822 }
2823 else if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2824 {
2825 unsigned long thickness, position;
2826 int y;
2827
2828 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2829 {
2830 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2831 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2832 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2833 }
2834 else
2835 {
2836 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2837 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2838 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2839 else
2840 thickness = 1;
2841 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2842 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2843 else
2844 {
2845 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2846 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2847 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2848 specs, and its default is
2849
2850 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2851 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2852
2853 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2854 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2855 position = s->font->underline_position;
2856 else if (s->font)
2857 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2858 else
2859 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2860 }
2861 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2862 }
2863 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2864 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2865 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2866 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2867 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2868 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2869 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2870 s->underline_position = position;
2871 y = s->ybase + position;
2872 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2873 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2874 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2875 else
2876 {
2877 XGCValues xgcv;
2878 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2879 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2880 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2881 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2882 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2883 }
2884 }
2885 }
2886 /* Draw overline. */
2887 if (s->face->overline_p)
2888 {
2889 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2890
2891 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2892 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2893 s->width, h);
2894 else
2895 {
2896 XGCValues xgcv;
2897 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2898 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2899 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2900 s->width, h);
2901 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2902 }
2903 }
2904
2905 /* Draw strike-through. */
2906 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2907 {
2908 unsigned long h = 1;
2909 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2910
2911 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2912 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2913 s->width, h);
2914 else
2915 {
2916 XGCValues xgcv;
2917 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2918 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2919 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2920 s->width, h);
2921 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2922 }
2923 }
2924
2925 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2926 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2927 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2928
2929 if (s->prev)
2930 {
2931 struct glyph_string *prev;
2932
2933 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2934 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2935 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2936 {
2937 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2938 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2939 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2940
2941 prev->hl = s->hl;
2942 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2943 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2944 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2945 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2946 else
2947 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2948 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2949 prev->hl = save;
2950 prev->num_clips = 0;
2951 }
2952 }
2953
2954 if (s->next)
2955 {
2956 struct glyph_string *next;
2957
2958 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2959 if (next->hl != s->hl
2960 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2961 {
2962 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2963 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2964 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2965
2966 next->hl = s->hl;
2967 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2968 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2969 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2970 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2971 else
2972 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2973 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2974 next->hl = save;
2975 next->num_clips = 0;
2976 next->clip_head = s->next;
2977 }
2978 }
2979 }
2980
2981 /* Reset clipping. */
2982 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2983 s->num_clips = 0;
2984 }
2985
2986 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2987
2988 static void
2989 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2990 {
2991 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2992 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2993 x, y, width, height,
2994 x + shift_by, y);
2995 }
2996
2997 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2998 for X frames. */
2999
3000 static void
3001 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
3002 {
3003 emacs_abort ();
3004 }
3005
3006
3007 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
3008 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
3009
3010 void
3011 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
3012 {
3013 eassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
3014 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
3015 }
3016
3017
3018 /* Clear an entire frame. */
3019
3020 static void
3021 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
3022 {
3023 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
3024 longer visible. */
3025 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
3026 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
3027 output_cursor.x = -1;
3028
3029 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
3030 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
3031 BLOCK_INPUT;
3032
3033 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
3034
3035 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
3036 something like that, then they should be notified. */
3037 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
3038
3039 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3040 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
3041 redisplay, do it here. */
3042 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
3043 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3044 #endif
3045
3046 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3047
3048 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3049 }
3050
3051
3052 \f
3053 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3054
3055 static void
3056 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3057 {
3058 BLOCK_INPUT;
3059
3060 {
3061 #ifdef USE_GTK
3062 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3063 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3064 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3065 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3066 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3067 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3068 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3069 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3070 do { \
3071 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3072 cairo_fill (cr); \
3073 } \
3074 while (0)
3075 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3076 GdkGCValues vals;
3077 GdkGC *gc;
3078 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3079 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3080 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3081 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3082 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3083 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3084 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3085 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3086 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3087 GC gc;
3088
3089 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3090 pixels into background pixels. */
3091 {
3092 XGCValues values;
3093
3094 values.function = GXxor;
3095 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3096 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3097
3098 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3099 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3100 }
3101 #endif
3102 {
3103 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3104 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3105 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3106 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3107 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3108 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3109 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3110
3111 int width;
3112
3113 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3114 edge it is next to. */
3115 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3116 {
3117 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3118 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3119 break;
3120
3121 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3122 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3123 break;
3124
3125 default:
3126 break;
3127 }
3128
3129 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3130
3131 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3132 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3133 {
3134 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3135 flash_left,
3136 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3137 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3138 width, flash_height);
3139 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3140 flash_left,
3141 (height - flash_height
3142 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3143 width, flash_height);
3144
3145 }
3146 else
3147 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3148 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3149 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3150 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3151
3152 x_flush (f);
3153
3154 {
3155 EMACS_TIME delay = make_emacs_time (0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3156 EMACS_TIME wakeup = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), delay);
3157
3158 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3159 available. */
3160 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3161 {
3162 EMACS_TIME current = current_emacs_time ();
3163 EMACS_TIME timeout;
3164
3165 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3166 if (EMACS_TIME_LE (wakeup, current))
3167 break;
3168
3169 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3170 timeout = make_emacs_time (0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3171
3172 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3173 pselect (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout, NULL);
3174 }
3175 }
3176
3177 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3178 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3179 {
3180 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3181 flash_left,
3182 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3183 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3184 width, flash_height);
3185 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3186 flash_left,
3187 (height - flash_height
3188 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3189 width, flash_height);
3190 }
3191 else
3192 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3193 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3194 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3195 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3196
3197 #ifdef USE_GTK
3198 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3199 cairo_destroy (cr);
3200 #else
3201 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3202 #endif
3203 #undef XFillRectangle
3204 #else
3205 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3206 #endif
3207 x_flush (f);
3208 }
3209 }
3210
3211 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3212 }
3213
3214
3215 static void
3216 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3217 {
3218 BLOCK_INPUT;
3219 if (invisible)
3220 {
3221 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3222 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3223 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3224 }
3225 else
3226 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3227 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3228 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3229 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3230 }
3231
3232
3233 /* Make audible bell. */
3234
3235 static void
3236 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3237 {
3238 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3239 {
3240 if (visible_bell)
3241 XTflash (f);
3242 else
3243 {
3244 BLOCK_INPUT;
3245 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3246 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3247 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3248 }
3249 }
3250 }
3251
3252 \f
3253 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3254 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3255 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3256 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3257
3258 static void
3259 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3260 {
3261 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3262 }
3263
3264
3265 \f
3266 /***********************************************************************
3267 Line Dance
3268 ***********************************************************************/
3269
3270 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3271 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3272
3273 static void
3274 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3275 {
3276 emacs_abort ();
3277 }
3278
3279
3280 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3281
3282 static void
3283 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3284 {
3285 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3286 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3287
3288 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3289 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3290 fringe of W. */
3291 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3292
3293 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3294 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3295 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3296 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3297 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3298 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3299 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3300 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3301 {
3302 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3303
3304 if (sb_width > 0)
3305 {
3306 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3307 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3308 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3309
3310 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3311 {
3312 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3313 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3314 }
3315 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3316 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3317 }
3318 }
3319 #endif
3320
3321 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3322 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3323 bottom_y = y + height;
3324
3325 if (to_y < from_y)
3326 {
3327 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3328 line at the bottom. */
3329 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3330 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3331 else
3332 height = run->height;
3333 }
3334 else
3335 {
3336 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3337 at the bottom. */
3338 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3339 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3340 else
3341 height = run->height;
3342 }
3343
3344 BLOCK_INPUT;
3345
3346 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3347 updated_window = w;
3348 x_clear_cursor (w);
3349
3350 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3351 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3352 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3353 x, from_y,
3354 width, height,
3355 x, to_y);
3356
3357 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3358 }
3359
3360
3361 \f
3362 /***********************************************************************
3363 Exposure Events
3364 ***********************************************************************/
3365
3366 \f
3367 static void
3368 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3369 {
3370 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3371 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3372 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3373 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3374 BLOCK_INPUT;
3375 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3376 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3377 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3378 because of this (bug#9310). */
3379 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3380 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3381 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3382 x_uncatch_errors ();
3383 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3384 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3385 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3386 }
3387
3388 static void
3389 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3390 {
3391 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3392 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3393 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3394 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3395 BLOCK_INPUT;
3396 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3397 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3398 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3399 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3400 x_uncatch_errors ();
3401 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3402 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3403 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3404 }
3405
3406 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3407 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3408 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3409 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3410 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3411
3412 static void
3413 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3414 {
3415 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3416
3417 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3418 {
3419 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3420 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3421 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3422
3423 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3424 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3425
3426 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3427 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3428 else
3429 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3430 }
3431
3432 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3433 }
3434
3435 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3436 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3437 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3438
3439 static void
3440 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3441 {
3442 if (type == FocusIn)
3443 {
3444 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3445 {
3446 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3447 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3448
3449 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3450 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3451 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3452 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3453 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3454 {
3455 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3456 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3457 }
3458 }
3459
3460 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3461
3462 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3463 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3464 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3465 #endif
3466 }
3467 else if (type == FocusOut)
3468 {
3469 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3470
3471 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3472 {
3473 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3474 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3475 }
3476
3477 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3478 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3479 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3480 #endif
3481 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3482 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3483 }
3484 }
3485
3486 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3487 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3488
3489 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3490
3491 static void
3492 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3493 {
3494 struct frame *frame;
3495
3496 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3497 if (! frame)
3498 return;
3499
3500 switch (event->type)
3501 {
3502 case EnterNotify:
3503 case LeaveNotify:
3504 {
3505 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3506 int focus_state
3507 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3508
3509 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3510 && event->xcrossing.focus
3511 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3512 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3513 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3514 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3515 }
3516 break;
3517
3518 case FocusIn:
3519 case FocusOut:
3520 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3521 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3522 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3523 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3524 break;
3525
3526 case ClientMessage:
3527 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3528 {
3529 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3530 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3531 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3532 }
3533 break;
3534 }
3535 }
3536
3537
3538 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3539 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3540
3541 void
3542 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3543 {
3544 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3545 }
3546 #endif
3547
3548 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3549 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3550 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3551
3552 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3553 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3554 the appropriate X display info. */
3555
3556 static void
3557 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3558 {
3559 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3560 }
3561
3562 static void
3563 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3564 {
3565 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3566
3567 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3568 {
3569 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3570 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3571 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3572 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3573 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3574 {
3575 fset_focus_frame (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame, Qnil);
3576 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3577 }
3578 }
3579 else
3580 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3581
3582 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3583 {
3584 if (old_highlight)
3585 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3586 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3587 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3588 }
3589 }
3590
3591
3592 \f
3593 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3594
3595 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3596 static void
3597 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3598 {
3599 int min_code, max_code;
3600 KeySym *syms;
3601 int syms_per_code;
3602 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3603
3604 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3605 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3606 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3607 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3608 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3609
3610 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3611
3612 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3613 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3614 &syms_per_code);
3615 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3616
3617 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3618 Alt keysyms are on. */
3619 {
3620 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3621 int found_alt_or_meta;
3622
3623 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3624 {
3625 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3626 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3627 {
3628 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3629
3630 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3631 if (code == 0)
3632 continue;
3633
3634 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3635 {
3636 int code_col;
3637
3638 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3639 {
3640 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3641
3642 switch (sym)
3643 {
3644 case XK_Meta_L:
3645 case XK_Meta_R:
3646 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3647 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3648 break;
3649
3650 case XK_Alt_L:
3651 case XK_Alt_R:
3652 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3653 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3654 break;
3655
3656 case XK_Hyper_L:
3657 case XK_Hyper_R:
3658 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3659 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3660 code_col = syms_per_code;
3661 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3662 break;
3663
3664 case XK_Super_L:
3665 case XK_Super_R:
3666 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3667 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3668 code_col = syms_per_code;
3669 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3670 break;
3671
3672 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3673 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3674 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3675 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3676 code_col = syms_per_code;
3677 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3678 break;
3679 }
3680 }
3681 }
3682 }
3683 }
3684 }
3685
3686 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3687 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3688 {
3689 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3690 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3691 }
3692
3693 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3694 make them just meta, not alt. */
3695 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3696 {
3697 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3698 }
3699
3700 XFree (syms);
3701 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3702 }
3703
3704 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3705 Emacs uses. */
3706
3707 int
3708 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3709 {
3710 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3711 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3712 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3713 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3714 Lisp_Object tem;
3715
3716 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3717 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3718 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3719 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3720 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3721 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3722 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3723 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3724
3725 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3726 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3727 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3728 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3729 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3730 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3731 }
3732
3733 static int
3734 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3735 {
3736 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3737 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3738 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3739 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3740
3741 Lisp_Object tem;
3742
3743 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3744 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3745 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3746 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3747 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3748 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3749 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3750 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3751
3752
3753 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3754 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3755 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3756 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3757 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3758 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3759 }
3760
3761 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3762
3763 char *
3764 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3765 {
3766 char *value;
3767
3768 BLOCK_INPUT;
3769 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3770 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3771
3772 return value;
3773 }
3774
3775
3776 \f
3777 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3778
3779 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3780
3781 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3782 the mouse. */
3783
3784 static Lisp_Object
3785 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3786 {
3787 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3788 otherwise. */
3789 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3790 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3791 result->timestamp = event->time;
3792 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3793 event->state)
3794 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3795 ? up_modifier
3796 : down_modifier));
3797
3798 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3799 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3800 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3801 result->arg = Qnil;
3802 return Qnil;
3803 }
3804
3805 \f
3806 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3807 The input handler calls this.
3808
3809 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3810 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3811 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3812 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3813
3814 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3815 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3816
3817 static int
3818 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3819 {
3820 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3821 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3822 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3823
3824 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3825 return 0;
3826
3827 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3828 {
3829 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3830 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3831 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3832 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3833 return 1;
3834 }
3835
3836
3837 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3838 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3839 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3840 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3841 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3842 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3843 {
3844 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3845 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3846 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3847 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3848 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3849 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3850 return 1;
3851 }
3852
3853 return 0;
3854 }
3855
3856 \f
3857 /************************************************************************
3858 Mouse Face
3859 ************************************************************************/
3860
3861 static void
3862 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3863 {
3864 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3865 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3866 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3867 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3868 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3869 }
3870
3871
3872
3873 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3874 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3875
3876 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3877 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3878 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3879 position on the scroll bar.
3880
3881 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3882 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3883 the mouse is over.
3884
3885 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3886 was at this position.
3887
3888 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3889
3890 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3891 movement. */
3892
3893 static void
3894 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3895 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3896 Time *timestamp)
3897 {
3898 FRAME_PTR f1;
3899
3900 BLOCK_INPUT;
3901
3902 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3903 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3904 else
3905 {
3906 Window root;
3907 int root_x, root_y;
3908
3909 Window dummy_window;
3910 int dummy;
3911
3912 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3913
3914 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3915 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3916 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3917 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3918 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3919
3920 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3921
3922 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3923 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3924 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3925
3926 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3927 &root,
3928
3929 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3930 a different screen. */
3931 &dummy_window,
3932
3933 /* The position on that root window. */
3934 &root_x, &root_y,
3935
3936 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3937 &dummy, &dummy,
3938
3939 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3940 we don't care. */
3941 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3942
3943 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3944 containing the pointer. */
3945 {
3946 Window win, child;
3947 int win_x, win_y;
3948 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3949
3950 win = root;
3951
3952 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3953 structure is changing at the same time this function
3954 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3955
3956 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3957
3958 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3959 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3960 {
3961 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3962 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3963 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3964
3965 /* From-window, to-window. */
3966 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3967
3968 /* From-position, to-position. */
3969 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3970
3971 /* Child of win. */
3972 &child);
3973 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3974 }
3975 else
3976 {
3977 while (1)
3978 {
3979 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3980
3981 /* From-window, to-window. */
3982 root, win,
3983
3984 /* From-position, to-position. */
3985 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3986
3987 /* Child of win. */
3988 &child);
3989
3990 if (child == None || child == win)
3991 break;
3992 #ifdef USE_GTK
3993 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3994 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3995 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3996 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3997 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3998 break;
3999 #endif
4000 win = child;
4001 parent_x = win_x;
4002 parent_y = win_y;
4003 }
4004
4005 /* Now we know that:
4006 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
4007 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
4008 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
4009 (XTC did this the last time through), and
4010 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
4011 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
4012 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
4013 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
4014 never use them in that case.) */
4015
4016 #ifdef USE_GTK
4017 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4018 want the edit window. */
4019 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4020 #else
4021 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4022 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4023 #endif
4024
4025 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4026 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4027 on the frame. */
4028 if (f1 != NULL
4029 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4030 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4031 f1 = NULL;
4032 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4033 }
4034
4035 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4036 f1 = 0;
4037
4038 x_uncatch_errors ();
4039
4040 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4041 if (! f1)
4042 {
4043 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4044
4045 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4046
4047 if (bar)
4048 {
4049 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4050 win_x = parent_x;
4051 win_y = parent_y;
4052 }
4053 }
4054
4055 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4056 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4057
4058 if (f1)
4059 {
4060 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4061 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4062 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4063 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4064 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4065 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4066 the frame are divided into. */
4067
4068 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4069 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4070
4071 *bar_window = Qnil;
4072 *part = 0;
4073 *fp = f1;
4074 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4075 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4076 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4077 }
4078 }
4079 }
4080
4081 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4082 }
4083
4084
4085 \f
4086 /***********************************************************************
4087 Scroll bars
4088 ***********************************************************************/
4089
4090 /* Scroll bar support. */
4091
4092 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4093 manages it.
4094 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4095 bits. */
4096
4097 static struct scroll_bar *
4098 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4099 {
4100 Lisp_Object tail;
4101
4102 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4103 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4104 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4105
4106 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4107 {
4108 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4109
4110 frame = XCAR (tail);
4111 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4112 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4113 emacs_abort ();
4114
4115 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4116 continue;
4117
4118 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4119 right window ID. */
4120 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4121 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4122 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4123 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4124 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4125 condemned = Qnil,
4126 ! NILP (bar));
4127 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4128 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4129 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4130 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4131 }
4132
4133 return NULL;
4134 }
4135
4136
4137 #if defined USE_LUCID
4138
4139 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4140 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4141
4142 static Widget
4143 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4144 {
4145 Lisp_Object tail;
4146
4147 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4148 {
4149 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4150 {
4151 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4152 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4153
4154 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4155 return menu_bar;
4156 }
4157 }
4158
4159 return NULL;
4160 }
4161
4162 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4163
4164 \f
4165 /************************************************************************
4166 Toolkit scroll bars
4167 ************************************************************************/
4168
4169 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4170
4171 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4172 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4173 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4174 struct scroll_bar *);
4175 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4176 int, int, int);
4177
4178
4179 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4180 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4181
4182 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4183
4184 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4185
4186 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4187
4188 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4189 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4190
4191 #ifndef USE_GTK
4192 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4193
4194 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4195
4196 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4197
4198 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4199 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4200 to avoid jerkiness. */
4201
4202 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4203
4204 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4205 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4206 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4207 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4208
4209 static void
4210 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4211 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4212 {
4213 int scroll_bar_p;
4214 const char *end_action;
4215
4216 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4217 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4218 end_action = "Release";
4219 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4220 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4221 end_action = "EndScroll";
4222 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4223
4224 if (scroll_bar_p
4225 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4226 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4227 {
4228 struct window *w;
4229
4230 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4231 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4232 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4233
4234 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4235 {
4236 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4237 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4238 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4239 }
4240 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4241 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4242
4243 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4244 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4245 }
4246 }
4247 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4248
4249 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4250 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4251
4252 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4253 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4254
4255
4256 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4257 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4258 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4259 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4260
4261 static void
4262 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4263 {
4264 XEvent event;
4265 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4266 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4267 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4268 ptrdiff_t i;
4269
4270 BLOCK_INPUT;
4271
4272 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4273 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4274 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4275 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4276 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4277 ev->format = 32;
4278
4279 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4280 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4281 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4282 into that array in the event. */
4283 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4284 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4285 break;
4286
4287 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4288 {
4289 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4290 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4291 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4292 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4293 scroll_bar_windows =
4294 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4295 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4296 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4297 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4298 }
4299
4300 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4301 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4302 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4303 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4304 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4305 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4306
4307 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4308 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4309 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4310 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4311 #endif
4312
4313 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4314 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4315 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4316 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4317 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4318 }
4319
4320
4321 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4322 in *IEVENT. */
4323
4324 static void
4325 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4326 {
4327 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4328 Lisp_Object window;
4329 struct window *w;
4330
4331 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4332 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4333
4334 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4335
4336 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4337 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4338 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4339 #ifdef USE_GTK
4340 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4341 #else
4342 ievent->timestamp =
4343 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4344 #endif
4345 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4346 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4347 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4348 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4349 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4350 }
4351
4352
4353 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4354
4355 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4356
4357 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4358
4359
4360 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4361 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4362 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4363
4364 static void
4365 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4366 {
4367 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4368 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4369 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4370
4371 switch (cs->reason)
4372 {
4373 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4374 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4375 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4376 break;
4377
4378 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4379 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4380 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4381 break;
4382
4383 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4384 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4385 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4386 break;
4387
4388 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4389 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4390 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4391 break;
4392
4393 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4394 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4395 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4396 break;
4397
4398 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4399 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4400 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4401 break;
4402
4403 case XmCR_DRAG:
4404 {
4405 int slider_size;
4406
4407 /* Get the slider size. */
4408 BLOCK_INPUT;
4409 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4410 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4411
4412 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4413 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4414 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4415 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4416 }
4417 break;
4418
4419 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4420 break;
4421 };
4422
4423 if (part >= 0)
4424 {
4425 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4426 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4427 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4428 }
4429 }
4430
4431 #elif defined USE_GTK
4432
4433 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4434 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4435
4436 static gboolean
4437 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4438 GtkScrollType scroll,
4439 gdouble value,
4440 gpointer user_data)
4441 {
4442 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4443 gdouble position;
4444 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4445 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4446 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4447
4448 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4449 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4450
4451
4452 switch (scroll)
4453 {
4454 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4455 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4456 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4457 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4458 {
4459 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4460 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4461 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4462 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4463 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4464 }
4465 break;
4466 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4467 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4468 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4469 break;
4470 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4471 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4472 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4473 break;
4474 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4475 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4476 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4477 break;
4478 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4479 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4480 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4481 break;
4482 }
4483
4484 if (part >= 0)
4485 {
4486 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4487 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4488 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4489 }
4490
4491 return FALSE;
4492 }
4493
4494 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4495
4496 static gboolean
4497 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4498 GdkEventButton *event,
4499 gpointer user_data)
4500 {
4501 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4502 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4503 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4504 {
4505 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4506 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4507 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4508 }
4509
4510 return FALSE;
4511 }
4512
4513
4514 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4515
4516 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4517 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4518 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4519 the thumb is. */
4520
4521 static void
4522 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4523 {
4524 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4525 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4526 float shown;
4527 int whole, portion, height;
4528 int part;
4529
4530 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4531 BLOCK_INPUT;
4532 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4533 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4534
4535 whole = 10000000;
4536 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4537
4538 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0f / height))
4539 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4540 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4541 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4542 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4543 bottom). */
4544 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4545 else
4546 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4547
4548 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4549 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4550 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4551 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4552 }
4553
4554
4555 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4556 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4557 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4558 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4559 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4560 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4561 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4562
4563 static void
4564 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4565 {
4566 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4567 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4568 int position = (long) call_data;
4569 Dimension height;
4570 int part;
4571
4572 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4573 BLOCK_INPUT;
4574 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4575 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4576
4577 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4578 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4579
4580 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4581 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4582 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4583 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4584 else
4585 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4586
4587 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4588 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4589 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4590 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4591 }
4592
4593 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4594
4595 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4596
4597 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4598 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4599
4600 #ifdef USE_GTK
4601 static void
4602 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4603 {
4604 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4605
4606 BLOCK_INPUT;
4607 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4608 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4609 scroll_bar_name);
4610 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4611 }
4612
4613 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4614
4615 static void
4616 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4617 {
4618 Window xwindow;
4619 Widget widget;
4620 Arg av[20];
4621 int ac = 0;
4622 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4623 unsigned long pixel;
4624
4625 BLOCK_INPUT;
4626
4627 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4628 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4629 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4630 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4631 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4632 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4633 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4634 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4635 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4636
4637 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4638 if (pixel != -1)
4639 {
4640 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4641 ++ac;
4642 }
4643
4644 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4645 if (pixel != -1)
4646 {
4647 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4648 ++ac;
4649 }
4650
4651 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4652 (char *) scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4653
4654 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4655 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4656 (XtPointer) bar);
4657 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4658 (XtPointer) bar);
4659 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4660 (XtPointer) bar);
4661 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4662 (XtPointer) bar);
4663 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4664 (XtPointer) bar);
4665 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4666 (XtPointer) bar);
4667 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4668 (XtPointer) bar);
4669
4670 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4671 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4672
4673 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4674 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4675 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4676 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4677
4678 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4679
4680 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4681 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4682 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4683 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4684 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4685 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4686 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4687 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4688
4689 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4690 if (pixel != -1)
4691 {
4692 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4693 ++ac;
4694 }
4695
4696 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4697 if (pixel != -1)
4698 {
4699 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4700 ++ac;
4701 }
4702
4703 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4704
4705 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4706 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4707 {
4708 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4709 if (pixel != -1)
4710 {
4711 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4712 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4713 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4714 pixel = -1;
4715 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4716 }
4717 }
4718 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4719 {
4720 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4721 if (pixel != -1)
4722 {
4723 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4724 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4725 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4726 pixel = -1;
4727 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4728 }
4729 }
4730
4731 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4732 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4733 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4734 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4735 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4736 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4737 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4738 colors itself. */
4739 {
4740 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4741 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4742 ++ac;
4743 }
4744 else
4745 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4746 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4747 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4748 {
4749 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4750 the shadows. */
4751 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4752 ++ac;
4753
4754 /* Specify the colors. */
4755 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4756 if (pixel != -1)
4757 {
4758 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4759 ++ac;
4760 }
4761 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4762 if (pixel != -1)
4763 {
4764 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4765 ++ac;
4766 }
4767 }
4768 #endif
4769
4770 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4771 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4772
4773 {
4774 char const *initial = "";
4775 char const *val = initial;
4776 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4777 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4778 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4779 #endif
4780 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4781 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4782 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4783 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4784 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4785 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4786 }
4787 }
4788
4789 /* Define callbacks. */
4790 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4791 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4792 (XtPointer) bar);
4793
4794 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4795 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4796
4797 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4798
4799 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4800 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4801 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4802 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4803
4804 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4805 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4806 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4807 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4808
4809 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4810 }
4811 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4812
4813
4814 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4815 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4816
4817 #ifdef USE_GTK
4818 static void
4819 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4820 {
4821 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4822 }
4823
4824 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4825 static void
4826 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4827 int whole)
4828 {
4829 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4830 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4831 float top, shown;
4832
4833 BLOCK_INPUT;
4834
4835 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4836
4837 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4838 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4839 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4840 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4841 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4842 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4843 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4844 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4845 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4846 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4847 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4848 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4849 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4850 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4851 whole += portion;
4852
4853 if (whole <= 0)
4854 top = 0, shown = 1;
4855 else
4856 {
4857 top = (float) position / whole;
4858 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4859 }
4860
4861 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4862 {
4863 int size, value;
4864
4865 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4866 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4867 value. */
4868 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4869 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4870 size = max (size, 1);
4871
4872 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4873 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4874 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4875
4876 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4877 }
4878 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4879
4880 if (whole == 0)
4881 top = 0, shown = 1;
4882 else
4883 {
4884 top = (float) position / whole;
4885 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4886 }
4887
4888 {
4889 float old_top, old_shown;
4890 Dimension height;
4891 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4892 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4893 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4894 XtNheight, &height,
4895 NULL);
4896
4897 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4898 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4899 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4900 else
4901 top = old_top;
4902 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4903 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
4904
4905 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4906 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4907 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4908 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4909 {
4910 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4911 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4912 else
4913 {
4914 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4915 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4916 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4917
4918 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4919 }
4920 }
4921 }
4922 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4923
4924 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4925 }
4926 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4927
4928 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4929
4930
4931 \f
4932 /************************************************************************
4933 Scroll bars, general
4934 ************************************************************************/
4935
4936 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4937 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4938 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4939 scroll bar. */
4940
4941 static struct scroll_bar *
4942 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4943 {
4944 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4945 struct scroll_bar *bar
4946 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4947 Lisp_Object barobj;
4948
4949 BLOCK_INPUT;
4950
4951 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4952 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4953 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4954 {
4955 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4956 unsigned long mask;
4957 Window window;
4958
4959 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4960 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4961 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4962
4963 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4964 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4965 | ExposureMask);
4966 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4967
4968 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4969
4970 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4971 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4972 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4973 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4974 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4975 left, top, width,
4976 window_box_height (w), False);
4977
4978 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4979 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4980 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4981 top,
4982 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4983 height,
4984 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4985 0,
4986 CopyFromParent,
4987 CopyFromParent,
4988 CopyFromParent,
4989 /* Attributes. */
4990 mask, &a);
4991 bar->x_window = window;
4992 }
4993 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4994
4995 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4996 bar->top = top;
4997 bar->left = left;
4998 bar->width = width;
4999 bar->height = height;
5000 bar->start = 0;
5001 bar->end = 0;
5002 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5003 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
5004
5005 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
5006 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5007 bar->prev = Qnil;
5008 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5009 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
5010 if (!NILP (bar->next))
5011 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5012
5013 /* Map the window/widget. */
5014 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5015 {
5016 #ifdef USE_GTK
5017 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5018 bar->x_window,
5019 top,
5020 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5021 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5022 max (height, 1));
5023 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5024 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5025 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
5026 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5027 top,
5028 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5029 max (height, 1), 0);
5030 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5031 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5032 }
5033 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5034 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5035 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5036
5037 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5038 return bar;
5039 }
5040
5041
5042 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5043
5044 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5045
5046 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5047 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5048 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5049 events.)
5050
5051 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5052 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5053 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5054 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5055 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5056
5057 static void
5058 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5059 {
5060 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5061 Window w = bar->x_window;
5062 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5063 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5064
5065 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5066 if (! rebuild
5067 && start == bar->start
5068 && end == bar->end)
5069 return;
5070
5071 BLOCK_INPUT;
5072
5073 {
5074 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5075 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5076 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5077
5078 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5079 the distance between start and end. */
5080 {
5081 int length = end - start;
5082
5083 if (start < 0)
5084 start = 0;
5085 else if (start > top_range)
5086 start = top_range;
5087 end = start + length;
5088
5089 if (end < start)
5090 end = start;
5091 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5092 end = top_range;
5093 }
5094
5095 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5096 bar->start = start;
5097 bar->end = end;
5098
5099 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5100 if (end > top_range)
5101 end = top_range;
5102
5103 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5104 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5105 that many pixels tall. */
5106 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5107
5108 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5109 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5110 if (0 < start)
5111 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5112 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5113 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5114 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5115 inside_width, start,
5116 False);
5117
5118 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5119 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5120 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5121 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5122
5123 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5124 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5125 /* x, y, width, height */
5126 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5127 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5128 inside_width, end - start);
5129
5130 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5131 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5132 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5133 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5134
5135 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5136 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5137 if (end < inside_height)
5138 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5139 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5140 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5141 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5142 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5143 False);
5144
5145 }
5146
5147 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5148 }
5149
5150 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5151
5152 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5153 nil. */
5154
5155 static void
5156 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5157 {
5158 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5159 BLOCK_INPUT;
5160
5161 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5162 #ifdef USE_GTK
5163 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5164 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5165 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5166 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5167 #else
5168 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5169 #endif
5170
5171 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5172 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar->window), Qnil);
5173
5174 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5175 }
5176
5177
5178 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5179 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5180 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5181 create one. */
5182
5183 static void
5184 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5185 {
5186 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5187 Lisp_Object barobj;
5188 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5189 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5190 int window_y, window_height;
5191 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5192 int fringe_extended_p;
5193 #endif
5194
5195 /* Get window dimensions. */
5196 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5197 top = window_y;
5198 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5199 height = window_height;
5200
5201 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5202 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5203
5204 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5205 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5206 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5207 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5208 else
5209 sb_width = width;
5210
5211 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5212 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5213 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5214 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5215 else
5216 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5217 #else
5218 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5219 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5220 else
5221 sb_left = left;
5222 #endif
5223
5224 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5225 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5226 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5227 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5228 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5229 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5230 else
5231 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5232 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5233 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5234 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5235 #endif
5236
5237 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5238 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5239 {
5240 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5241 {
5242 BLOCK_INPUT;
5243 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5244 if (fringe_extended_p)
5245 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5246 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5247 else
5248 #endif
5249 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5250 left, top, width, height, False);
5251 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5252 }
5253
5254 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5255 }
5256 else
5257 {
5258 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5259 unsigned int mask = 0;
5260
5261 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5262
5263 BLOCK_INPUT;
5264
5265 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5266 mask |= CWX;
5267 if (top != bar->top)
5268 mask |= CWY;
5269 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5270 mask |= CWWidth;
5271 if (height != bar->height)
5272 mask |= CWHeight;
5273
5274 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5275
5276 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5277 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5278 {
5279 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5280 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5281 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5282 {
5283 if (fringe_extended_p)
5284 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5285 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5286 else
5287 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5288 left, top, width, height, False);
5289 }
5290 #ifdef USE_GTK
5291 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5292 bar->x_window,
5293 top,
5294 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5295 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5296 max (height, 1));
5297 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5298 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5299 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5300 top,
5301 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5302 max (height, 1), 0);
5303 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5304 }
5305 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5306
5307 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5308 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5309 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5310 {
5311 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5312 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5313 height, False);
5314 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5315 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5316 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5317 height, False);
5318 }
5319
5320 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5321 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5322 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5323 example. */
5324 {
5325 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5326 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5327 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5328 {
5329 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5330 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5331 left + area_width - rest, top,
5332 rest, height, False);
5333 else
5334 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5335 left, top, rest, height, False);
5336 }
5337 }
5338
5339 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5340 if (mask)
5341 {
5342 XWindowChanges wc;
5343
5344 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5345 wc.y = top;
5346 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5347 wc.height = height;
5348 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5349 mask, &wc);
5350 }
5351
5352 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5353
5354 /* Remember new settings. */
5355 bar->left = sb_left;
5356 bar->top = top;
5357 bar->width = sb_width;
5358 bar->height = height;
5359
5360 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5361 }
5362
5363 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5364 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5365
5366 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5367 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5368 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5369 dragged. */
5370 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5371 {
5372 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5373
5374 if (whole == 0)
5375 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5376 else
5377 {
5378 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5379 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5380 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5381 }
5382 }
5383 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5384
5385 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5386 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, barobj);
5387 }
5388
5389
5390 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5391 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5392 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5393 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5394 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5395 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5396 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5397
5398 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5399 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5400 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5401
5402 static void
5403 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5404 {
5405 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5406 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5407 {
5408 Lisp_Object bar;
5409 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5410 fset_scroll_bars (frame, XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next);
5411 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5412 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5413 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5414 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5415 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (frame, bar);
5416 }
5417 }
5418
5419
5420 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5421 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5422
5423 static void
5424 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5425 {
5426 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5427 struct frame *f;
5428 Lisp_Object barobj;
5429
5430 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5431 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5432 emacs_abort ();
5433
5434 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5435
5436 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5437 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5438 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5439 {
5440 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5441 the lists. */
5442 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5443 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5444 return;
5445 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5446 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5447 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, bar->next);
5448 else
5449 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5450 one or the other! */
5451 emacs_abort ();
5452 }
5453 else
5454 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5455
5456 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5457 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5458
5459 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5460 bar->prev = Qnil;
5461 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5462 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
5463 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5464 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5465 }
5466
5467 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5468 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5469
5470 static void
5471 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5472 {
5473 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5474
5475 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5476
5477 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5478 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5479 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, Qnil);
5480
5481 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5482 {
5483 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5484
5485 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5486
5487 next = b->next;
5488 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5489 }
5490
5491 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5492 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5493 }
5494
5495
5496 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5497 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5498 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5499
5500 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5501 mark bits. */
5502
5503 static void
5504 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5505 {
5506 Window w = bar->x_window;
5507 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5508 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5509 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5510
5511 BLOCK_INPUT;
5512
5513 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5514
5515 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5516 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5517 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5518 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5519
5520 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5521 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5522
5523 /* x, y, width, height */
5524 0, 0,
5525 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5526 bar->height - 1);
5527
5528 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5529 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5530 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5531 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5532
5533 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5534
5535 }
5536 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5537
5538 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5539 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5540
5541 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5542 mark bits. */
5543
5544
5545 static void
5546 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5547 {
5548 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5549 emacs_abort ();
5550
5551 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5552 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5553 emacs_event->modifiers
5554 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5555 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5556 event->xbutton.state)
5557 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5558 ? up_modifier
5559 : down_modifier));
5560 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5561 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5562 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5563 {
5564 int top_range
5565 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5566 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5567
5568 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5569 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5570
5571 if (y < bar->start)
5572 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5573 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5574 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5575 else
5576 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5577
5578 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5579 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5580 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5581 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5582 {
5583 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5584 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5585
5586 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5587 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5588 }
5589 #endif
5590
5591 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5592 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5593 }
5594 }
5595
5596 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5597
5598 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5599
5600 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5601 mark bits. */
5602
5603 static void
5604 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5605 {
5606 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5607
5608 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5609
5610 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5611 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5612
5613 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5614 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5615 {
5616 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5617 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5618
5619 if (new_start != bar->start)
5620 {
5621 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5622
5623 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5624 }
5625 }
5626 }
5627
5628 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5629
5630 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5631 on the scroll bar. */
5632
5633 static void
5634 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5635 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5636 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5637 {
5638 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5639 Window w = bar->x_window;
5640 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5641 int win_x, win_y;
5642 Window dummy_window;
5643 int dummy_coord;
5644 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5645
5646 BLOCK_INPUT;
5647
5648 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5649 report that. */
5650 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5651
5652 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5653 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5654 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5655
5656 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5657 &win_x, &win_y,
5658
5659 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5660 &dummy_mask))
5661 ;
5662 else
5663 {
5664 int top_range
5665 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5666
5667 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5668
5669 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5670 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5671
5672 if (win_y < 0)
5673 win_y = 0;
5674 if (win_y > top_range)
5675 win_y = top_range;
5676
5677 *fp = f;
5678 *bar_window = bar->window;
5679
5680 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5681 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5682 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5683 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5684 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5685 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5686 else
5687 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5688
5689 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5690 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5691
5692 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5693 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5694 }
5695
5696 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5697
5698 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5699 }
5700
5701
5702 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5703 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5704 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5705 redraw them. */
5706
5707 static void
5708 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5709 {
5710 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5711 Lisp_Object bar;
5712
5713 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5714 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5715 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5716 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5717 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5718 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5719 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5720 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5721 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5722 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5723 }
5724
5725 \f
5726 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5727
5728 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5729 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5730 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5731 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5732
5733 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5734 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5735
5736 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5737
5738 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5739 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5740
5741 static int temp_index;
5742 static short temp_buffer[100];
5743
5744 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5745 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5746 temp_index = 0; \
5747 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5748
5749 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5750 on a particular display. */
5751
5752 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5753
5754 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5755 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5756 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5757 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5758
5759 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5760
5761 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5762 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5763 do \
5764 { \
5765 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5766 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = \
5767 xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5768 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5769 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5770 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5771 } \
5772 while (0)
5773 #endif
5774
5775 enum
5776 {
5777 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5778 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5779 X_EVENT_DROP
5780 };
5781
5782 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5783 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5784 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5785
5786 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5787 this event further.
5788 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5789
5790 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5791 static int
5792 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5793 {
5794 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5795 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5796 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5797 was created. */
5798
5799 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5800 event->xclient.window);
5801
5802 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5803 }
5804 #endif
5805
5806 #ifdef USE_GTK
5807 static int current_count;
5808 static int current_finish;
5809 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5810
5811 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5812 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5813 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5814 static GdkFilterReturn
5815 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5816 {
5817 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5818
5819 BLOCK_INPUT;
5820 if (current_count >= 0)
5821 {
5822 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5823
5824 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5825
5826 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5827 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5828 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5829 so we do it here. */
5830 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5831 && dpyinfo
5832 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5833 {
5834 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5835 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5836 }
5837 #endif
5838
5839 if (! dpyinfo)
5840 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5841 else
5842 current_count +=
5843 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5844 current_hold_quit);
5845 }
5846 else
5847 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5848
5849 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5850
5851 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5852 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5853
5854 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5855 }
5856 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5857
5858
5859 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5860 enum xembed_message,
5861 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5862
5863 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5864
5865 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5866 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5867 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5868
5869 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5870
5871 static int
5872 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5873 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5874 {
5875 union {
5876 struct input_event ie;
5877 struct selection_input_event sie;
5878 } inev;
5879 int count = 0;
5880 int do_help = 0;
5881 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5882 struct frame *f = NULL;
5883 struct coding_system coding;
5884 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5885 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5886 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5887
5888 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5889
5890 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5891 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5892 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5893
5894 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5895 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5896
5897 switch (event.type)
5898 {
5899 case ClientMessage:
5900 {
5901 if (event.xclient.message_type
5902 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5903 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5904 {
5905 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5906 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5907 {
5908 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5909 could be the shell widget window
5910 if the frame has no title bar. */
5911 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5912 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5913 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5914 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5915 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5916 #endif
5917 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5918 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5919 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5920 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5921 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5922 needed.
5923
5924 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5925 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5926 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5927 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5928 Emacs. */
5929
5930 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5931 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5932 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5933 if (f)
5934 {
5935 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5936 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5937 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5938 x_catch_errors (d);
5939 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5940 /* The ICCCM says this is
5941 the only valid choice. */
5942 RevertToParent,
5943 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5944 /* This is needed to detect the error
5945 if there is an error. */
5946 XSync (d, False);
5947 x_uncatch_errors ();
5948 }
5949 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5950 #endif /* 0 */
5951 goto done;
5952 }
5953
5954 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5955 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5956 {
5957 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5958 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5959 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5960 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5961 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5962 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5963 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5964 session manager and one for this. */
5965 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5966 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5967 #endif
5968 {
5969 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5970 event.xclient.window);
5971 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5972 for a single Emacs process. */
5973 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5974 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5975 event.xclient.window,
5976 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5977 else if (f)
5978 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5979 event.xclient.window,
5980 0, 0);
5981 }
5982 goto done;
5983 }
5984
5985 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5986 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5987 {
5988 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5989 event.xclient.window);
5990 if (!f)
5991 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5992
5993 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5994 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5995 goto done;
5996 }
5997
5998 goto done;
5999 }
6000
6001 if (event.xclient.message_type
6002 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
6003 {
6004 goto done;
6005 }
6006
6007 if (event.xclient.message_type
6008 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
6009 {
6010 int new_x, new_y;
6011 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6012
6013 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
6014 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
6015
6016 if (f)
6017 {
6018 f->left_pos = new_x;
6019 f->top_pos = new_y;
6020 }
6021 goto done;
6022 }
6023
6024 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
6025 if (event.xclient.message_type
6026 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6027 {
6028 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6029 if (f)
6030 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
6031 &event, NULL);
6032 goto done;
6033 }
6034 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6035
6036 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6037 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6038 || (event.xclient.message_type
6039 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6040 {
6041 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6042 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6043 currently never do because we are interested in
6044 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6045 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6046 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6047 if (!f)
6048 goto OTHER;
6049 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6050 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6051 goto done;
6052 }
6053
6054 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6055 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6056 we construct an input_event. */
6057 if (event.xclient.message_type
6058 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6059 {
6060 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6061 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6062 goto done;
6063 }
6064 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6065
6066 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6067 if (event.xclient.message_type
6068 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6069 {
6070 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6071 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6072 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6073
6074 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6075 goto done;
6076 }
6077
6078 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6079
6080 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6081 if (!f)
6082 goto OTHER;
6083 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6084 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6085 }
6086 break;
6087
6088 case SelectionNotify:
6089 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6090 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6091 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6092 goto OTHER;
6093 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6094 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6095 break;
6096
6097 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6098 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6099 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6100 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6101 goto OTHER;
6102 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6103 {
6104 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6105
6106 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6107 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6108 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6109 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6110 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6111 }
6112 break;
6113
6114 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6115 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6117 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6118 goto OTHER;
6119 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6120 {
6121 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6122
6123 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6124 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6125 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6126 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6127 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6128 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6129 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6130 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6131 }
6132 break;
6133
6134 case PropertyNotify:
6135 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6136 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6137 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6138 if (x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty) && f->iconified
6139 && f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen)
6140 {
6141 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed. It hides
6142 the frame. So if our state says we aren't hidden anymore,
6143 treat it as deiconified. */
6144 if (! f->async_iconified)
6145 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6146 f->async_visible = 1;
6147 f->async_iconified = 0;
6148 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6149 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 0;
6150 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6151 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6152 }
6153
6154 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6155 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6156 goto OTHER;
6157
6158 case ReparentNotify:
6159 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6160 if (f)
6161 {
6162 int x, y;
6163 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6164 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6165 f->left_pos = x;
6166 f->top_pos = y;
6167
6168 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6169 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6170 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6171
6172 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6173 }
6174 goto OTHER;
6175
6176 case Expose:
6177 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6178 if (f)
6179 {
6180 #ifdef USE_GTK
6181 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6182 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6183 event.xexpose.window,
6184 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6185 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6186 FALSE);
6187 #endif
6188 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6189 {
6190 f->async_visible = 1;
6191 f->async_iconified = 0;
6192 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6193 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6194 }
6195 else
6196 expose_frame (f,
6197 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6198 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6199 }
6200 else
6201 {
6202 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6203 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6204 #endif
6205 #if defined USE_LUCID
6206 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6207 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6208 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6209 {
6210 Widget widget
6211 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6212 if (widget)
6213 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6214 }
6215 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6216
6217 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6218 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6219 goto OTHER;
6220 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6221 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6222 event.xexpose.window);
6223
6224 if (bar)
6225 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6226 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6227 else
6228 goto OTHER;
6229 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6230 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6231 }
6232 break;
6233
6234 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6235 source area was obscured or not
6236 available. */
6237 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6238 if (f)
6239 {
6240 expose_frame (f,
6241 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6242 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6243 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6244 }
6245 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6246 else
6247 goto OTHER;
6248 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6249 break;
6250
6251 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6252 source area was completely
6253 available. */
6254 break;
6255
6256 case UnmapNotify:
6257 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6258 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6259 {
6260 tip_window = 0;
6261 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6262 }
6263
6264 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6265 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6266 the frame was deleted. */
6267 {
6268 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6269 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6270 display that won't ever be seen. */
6271 f->async_visible = 0;
6272 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6273 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6274 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6275 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6276 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6277 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6278 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6279 {
6280 f->async_iconified = 1;
6281
6282 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6283 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6284 }
6285 }
6286 goto OTHER;
6287
6288 case MapNotify:
6289 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6290 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6291 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6292 goto OTHER;
6293
6294 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6295 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6296 frame is visible. */
6297 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6298 if (f)
6299 {
6300 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6301 the frame's display structures.
6302 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6303 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6304 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6305 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6306 if (! f->async_iconified)
6307 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6308
6309 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6310 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6311 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6312 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6313
6314 f->async_visible = 1;
6315 f->async_iconified = 0;
6316 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6317
6318 if (f->iconified)
6319 {
6320 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6321 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6322 }
6323 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6324 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6325 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6326 to update the frame titles
6327 in case this is the second frame. */
6328 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6329
6330 #ifdef USE_GTK
6331 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6332 #endif
6333 }
6334 goto OTHER;
6335
6336 case KeyPress:
6337
6338 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6339 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6340
6341 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6342 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6343 if (popup_activated ())
6344 goto OTHER;
6345 #endif
6346
6347 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6348
6349 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6350 mouse highlighting. */
6351 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6352 && (f == 0
6353 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6354 {
6355 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6356 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6357 }
6358
6359 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6360 if (f == 0)
6361 {
6362 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6363 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6364 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6365 event.xkey.window);
6366 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6367 {
6368 widget = XtParent (widget);
6369 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6370 }
6371 }
6372 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6373
6374 if (f != 0)
6375 {
6376 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6377 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6378 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6379 his Emacs hang.
6380
6381 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6382 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6383 status_return even if the input is too long to
6384 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6385 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6386 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6387 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6388 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6389 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6390 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6391 int modifiers;
6392 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6393 Lisp_Object c;
6394
6395 #ifdef USE_GTK
6396 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6397 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6398 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6399 (see above). */
6400 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6401 #endif
6402
6403 event.xkey.state
6404 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6405 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6406 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6407
6408 /* This will have to go some day... */
6409
6410 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6411 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6412 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6413 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6414 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6415 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6416 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6417
6418 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6419 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6420 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6421 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6422 not it is combined with Meta. */
6423 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6424 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6425
6426 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6427 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6428 {
6429 Status status_return;
6430
6431 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6432 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6433 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6434 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6435 &status_return);
6436 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6437 {
6438 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6439 copy_bufptr = alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6440 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6441 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6442 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6443 &status_return);
6444 }
6445 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6446 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6447 break;
6448 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6449 {
6450 keysym = NoSymbol;
6451 modifiers = 0;
6452 }
6453 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6454 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6455 emacs_abort ();
6456 }
6457 else
6458 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6459 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6460 &compose_status);
6461 #else
6462 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6463 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6464 &compose_status);
6465 #endif
6466
6467 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6468 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6469 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6470 break;
6471
6472 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6473 orig_keysym = keysym;
6474
6475 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6476 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6477 inev.ie.modifiers
6478 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6479 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6480
6481 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6482 translations to characters. */
6483 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6484 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6485 {
6486 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6487 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6488 goto done_keysym;
6489 }
6490
6491 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6492 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6493 {
6494 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6495 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6496 else
6497 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6498 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6499 goto done_keysym;
6500 }
6501
6502 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6503 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6504 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6505 Vx_keysym_table,
6506 Qnil),
6507 NATNUMP (c)))
6508 {
6509 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6510 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6511 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6512 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6513 goto done_keysym;
6514 }
6515
6516 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6517 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6518 || keysym == XK_Delete
6519 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6520 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6521 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6522 #endif
6523 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6524 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6525 #ifdef HPUX
6526 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6527 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6528 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6529 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6530 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6531 #endif
6532 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6533 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6534 #endif
6535 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6536 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6537 #endif
6538 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6539 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6540 #endif
6541 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6542 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6543 #endif
6544 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6545 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6546 #endif
6547 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6548 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6549 #endif
6550 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6551 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6552 #endif
6553 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6554 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6555 #endif
6556 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6557 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6558 #endif
6559 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6560 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6561 #endif
6562 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6563 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6564 #endif
6565 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6566 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6567 #endif
6568 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6569 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6570 #endif
6571 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6572 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6573 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6574 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6575 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6576 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6577 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6578 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6579 don't have real modifiers but
6580 should be treated similarly to
6581 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6582 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6583 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6584 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6585 #endif
6586 ))
6587 {
6588 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6589 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6590 key. */
6591 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6592 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6593 goto done_keysym;
6594 }
6595
6596 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6597 ptrdiff_t i;
6598 int nchars, len;
6599
6600 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6601 {
6602 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6603 nchars++;
6604 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6605 }
6606
6607 if (nchars < nbytes)
6608 {
6609 /* Decode the input data. */
6610
6611 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6612 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6613 we used just above and the locale. */
6614 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6615 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6616 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6617 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6618 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6619 gives us composition information. */
6620 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6621
6622 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6623 nbytes);
6624 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6625 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6626 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6627 nbytes = coding.produced;
6628 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6629 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6630 }
6631
6632 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6633 character events. */
6634 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6635 {
6636 int ch;
6637 if (nchars == nbytes)
6638 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6639 else
6640 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6641 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6642 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6643 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6644 inev.ie.code = ch;
6645 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6646 }
6647
6648 count += nchars;
6649
6650 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6651
6652 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6653 break;
6654 }
6655 }
6656 done_keysym:
6657 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6658 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6659 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6660 client. */
6661 break;
6662 #else
6663 goto OTHER;
6664 #endif
6665
6666 case KeyRelease:
6667 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6668 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6669 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6670 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6671 client. */
6672 break;
6673 #else
6674 goto OTHER;
6675 #endif
6676
6677 case EnterNotify:
6678 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6679 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6680
6681 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6682
6683 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6684 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6685
6686 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6687 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6688 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6689 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6690 #ifdef USE_GTK
6691 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6692 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6693 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6694 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6695 #endif
6696 goto OTHER;
6697
6698 case FocusIn:
6699 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6700 goto OTHER;
6701
6702 case LeaveNotify:
6703 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6704 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6705
6706 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6707 if (f)
6708 {
6709 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6710 {
6711 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6712 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6713 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6714 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6715 }
6716
6717 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6718 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6719 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6720 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6721 if (any_help_event_p)
6722 do_help = -1;
6723 }
6724 #ifdef USE_GTK
6725 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6726 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6727 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6728 #endif
6729 goto OTHER;
6730
6731 case FocusOut:
6732 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6733 goto OTHER;
6734
6735 case MotionNotify:
6736 {
6737 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6738 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6739 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6740
6741 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6742 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6743 f = last_mouse_frame;
6744 else
6745 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6746
6747 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6748 {
6749 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6750 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6751 }
6752
6753 #ifdef USE_GTK
6754 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6755 f = 0;
6756 #endif
6757 if (f)
6758 {
6759
6760 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6761 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6762 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6763 {
6764 Lisp_Object window;
6765
6766 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6767 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6768 0, 0);
6769
6770 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6771 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6772 will be selected only when it is active. */
6773 if (WINDOWP (window)
6774 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6775 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6776 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6777 create event iff we don't leave the
6778 selected frame. */
6779 && (focus_follows_mouse
6780 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6781 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6782 {
6783 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6784 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6785 }
6786
6787 last_window=window;
6788 }
6789 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6790 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6791 }
6792 else
6793 {
6794 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6795 struct scroll_bar *bar
6796 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6797 event.xmotion.window);
6798
6799 if (bar)
6800 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6801 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6802
6803 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6804 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6805 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6806 }
6807
6808 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6809 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6810 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6811 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6812 do_help = 1;
6813 goto OTHER;
6814 }
6815
6816 case ConfigureNotify:
6817 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6818 #ifdef USE_GTK
6819 if (!f
6820 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6821 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6822 {
6823 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6824 event.xconfigure.height);
6825 f = 0;
6826 }
6827 #endif
6828 if (f)
6829 {
6830 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6831 #ifndef USE_GTK
6832 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6833 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6834
6835 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6836 is called by the code that handles resizing
6837 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6838
6839 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6840 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6841 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6842 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6843 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6844 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6845 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6846 {
6847 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6848 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6849 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6850 }
6851
6852 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6853 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6854 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6855 #endif
6856
6857 #ifdef USE_GTK
6858 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6859 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6860 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6861 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6862 #endif
6863 {
6864 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6865 }
6866
6867 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6868 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6869 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6870 #endif
6871
6872 }
6873 goto OTHER;
6874
6875 case ButtonRelease:
6876 case ButtonPress:
6877 {
6878 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6879 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6880 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6881
6882 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6883 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6884 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6885
6886 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6887 && last_mouse_frame
6888 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6889 f = last_mouse_frame;
6890 else
6891 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6892
6893 #ifdef USE_GTK
6894 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6895 f = 0;
6896 #endif
6897 if (f)
6898 {
6899 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6900 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6901 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6902 {
6903 Lisp_Object window;
6904 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6905 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6906
6907 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6908 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6909
6910 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6911 {
6912 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6913 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6914 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6915 event.xbutton.state));
6916 }
6917 }
6918
6919 if (!tool_bar_p)
6920 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6921 if (! popup_activated ())
6922 #endif
6923 {
6924 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6925 {
6926 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6927 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6928 {
6929 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6930 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6931 }
6932 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6933 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6934 }
6935 else
6936 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6937 }
6938 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6939 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6940 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6941 }
6942 else
6943 {
6944 struct scroll_bar *bar
6945 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6946 event.xbutton.window);
6947
6948 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6949 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6950 scroll bars. */
6951 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6952 {
6953 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6954 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6955 }
6956 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6957 if (bar)
6958 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6959 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6960 }
6961
6962 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6963 {
6964 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6965 last_mouse_frame = f;
6966
6967 if (!tool_bar_p)
6968 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6969 }
6970 else
6971 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6972
6973 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6974 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6975 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6976 if (f != 0)
6977 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6978
6979 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6980 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6981 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6982 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6983 Instead, save it away
6984 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6985 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6986 if (! popup_activated ()
6987 #ifdef USE_GTK
6988 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6989 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6990 #endif
6991 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6992 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6993 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6994 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6995 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6996 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6997 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6998 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6999 {
7000 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
7001 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
7002 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
7003 }
7004 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
7005 {
7006 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
7007 goto OTHER;
7008 }
7009 else
7010 goto OTHER;
7011 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
7012 }
7013 break;
7014
7015 case CirculateNotify:
7016 goto OTHER;
7017
7018 case CirculateRequest:
7019 goto OTHER;
7020
7021 case VisibilityNotify:
7022 goto OTHER;
7023
7024 case MappingNotify:
7025 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
7026 local cache. */
7027 switch (event.xmapping.request)
7028 {
7029 case MappingModifier:
7030 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
7031 /* This is meant to fall through. */
7032 case MappingKeyboard:
7033 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
7034 }
7035 goto OTHER;
7036
7037 case DestroyNotify:
7038 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
7039 break;
7040
7041 default:
7042 OTHER:
7043 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7044 BLOCK_INPUT;
7045 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7046 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7047 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7048 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7049 break;
7050 }
7051
7052 done:
7053 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7054 {
7055 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7056 count++;
7057 }
7058
7059 if (do_help
7060 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7061 {
7062 Lisp_Object frame;
7063
7064 if (f)
7065 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7066 else
7067 frame = Qnil;
7068
7069 if (do_help > 0)
7070 {
7071 any_help_event_p = 1;
7072 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7073 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7074 }
7075 else
7076 {
7077 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7078 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7079 }
7080 count++;
7081 }
7082
7083 SAFE_FREE ();
7084 *eventptr = event;
7085 return count;
7086 }
7087
7088 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7089
7090 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7091 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7092 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7093
7094 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7095 int
7096 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7097 {
7098 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7099 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7100
7101 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7102
7103 if (dpyinfo)
7104 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7105
7106 return finish;
7107 }
7108 #endif
7109
7110
7111 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7112 Return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7113
7114 Return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7115 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7116 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7117 C chars). */
7118
7119 static int
7120 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7121 {
7122 int count = 0;
7123 int event_found = 0;
7124
7125 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7126 {
7127 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7128 pending_signals = 1;
7129 return -1;
7130 }
7131
7132 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7133 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
7134 BLOCK_INPUT;
7135
7136 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7137 input_signal_count++;
7138
7139 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7140 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7141 {
7142 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7143 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7144 }
7145
7146 #ifndef USE_GTK
7147 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7148 {
7149 int finish;
7150 XEvent event;
7151
7152 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7153
7154 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7155 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7156 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7157 continue;
7158 #endif
7159 event_found = 1;
7160
7161 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7162 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7163
7164 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7165 goto out;
7166 }
7167
7168 out:;
7169
7170 #else /* USE_GTK */
7171
7172 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7173 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7174 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7175 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7176
7177 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7178 from all displays. */
7179
7180 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7181 {
7182 current_count = count;
7183 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7184
7185 gtk_main_iteration ();
7186
7187 count = current_count;
7188 current_count = -1;
7189 current_hold_quit = 0;
7190
7191 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7192 break;
7193 }
7194 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7195
7196 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7197 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7198 if (! event_found)
7199 {
7200 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7201 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7202 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7203 x_noop_count++;
7204 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7205 {
7206 x_noop_count=0;
7207
7208 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7209 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7210
7211 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7212
7213 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7214 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7215 }
7216 }
7217
7218 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7219 raise it now. */
7220 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7221 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7222 {
7223 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7224 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7225 }
7226
7227 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7228
7229 return count;
7230 }
7231
7232
7233
7234 \f
7235 /***********************************************************************
7236 Text Cursor
7237 ***********************************************************************/
7238
7239 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7240 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7241
7242 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7243 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7244 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7245
7246 static void
7247 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7248 {
7249 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7250 XRectangle clip_rect;
7251 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7252
7253 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7254
7255 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7256 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7257 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7258 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7259 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7260
7261 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7262 }
7263
7264
7265 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7266
7267 static void
7268 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7269 {
7270 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7271 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7272 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7273 int x, y, wd, h;
7274 XGCValues xgcv;
7275 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7276 GC gc;
7277
7278 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7279 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7280 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7281 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7282 return;
7283
7284 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7285 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7286 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7287
7288 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7289 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7290 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7291 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7292 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7293 else
7294 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7295 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7296 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7297
7298 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7299 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7300 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7301 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7302 }
7303
7304
7305 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7306
7307 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7308 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7309 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7310 --gerd. */
7311
7312 static void
7313 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7314 {
7315 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7316 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7317
7318 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7319 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7320 and mini-buffer. */
7321 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7322 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7323 return;
7324
7325 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7326 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7327 the bar might not be in the window. */
7328 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7329 {
7330 struct glyph_row *r;
7331 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7332 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7333 }
7334 else
7335 {
7336 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7337 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7338 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7339 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7340 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7341 XGCValues xgcv;
7342
7343 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7344 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7345 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7346 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7347 that the glyph is legible. */
7348 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7349 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7350 else
7351 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7352 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7353
7354 if (gc)
7355 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7356 else
7357 {
7358 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7359 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7360 }
7361
7362 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7363
7364 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7365 {
7366 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7367
7368 if (width < 0)
7369 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7370 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7371
7372 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7373
7374 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7375 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7376 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7377 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7378
7379 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7380 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7381 width, row->height);
7382 }
7383 else
7384 {
7385 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7386
7387 if (width < 0)
7388 width = row->height;
7389
7390 width = min (row->height, width);
7391
7392 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7393 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7394
7395 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7396 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7397 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7398 row->height - width),
7399 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7400 }
7401
7402 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7403 }
7404 }
7405
7406
7407 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7408
7409 static void
7410 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7411 {
7412 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7413 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7414 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7415 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7416 }
7417
7418
7419 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7420
7421 static void
7422 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7423 {
7424 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7425 x, y, width, height, False);
7426 #ifdef USE_GTK
7427 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7428 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7429 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7430 #endif
7431 }
7432
7433
7434 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7435
7436 static void
7437 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7438 {
7439 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7440
7441 if (on_p)
7442 {
7443 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7444 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7445
7446 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7447 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7448 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7449 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7450 {
7451 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7452 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7453 }
7454 else
7455 {
7456 switch (cursor_type)
7457 {
7458 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7459 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7460 break;
7461
7462 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7463 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7464 break;
7465
7466 case BAR_CURSOR:
7467 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7468 break;
7469
7470 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7471 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7472 break;
7473
7474 case NO_CURSOR:
7475 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7476 break;
7477
7478 default:
7479 emacs_abort ();
7480 }
7481 }
7482
7483 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7484 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7485 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7486 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7487 #endif
7488 }
7489
7490 #ifndef XFlush
7491 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7492 #endif
7493 }
7494
7495 \f
7496 /* Icons. */
7497
7498 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7499
7500 int
7501 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7502 {
7503 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7504
7505 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7506 return 1;
7507
7508 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7509 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7510 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7511 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7512
7513 if (STRINGP (file))
7514 {
7515 #ifdef USE_GTK
7516 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7517 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7518 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7519 return 0;
7520 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7521 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7522 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7523 }
7524 else
7525 {
7526 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7527 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7528 {
7529 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7530
7531 #ifdef USE_GTK
7532
7533 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7534 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7535 return 0;
7536
7537 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7538
7539 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7540 if (rc != -1)
7541 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7542
7543 #endif
7544
7545 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7546 if (rc == -1)
7547 {
7548 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7549 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7550 if (rc == -1)
7551 return 1;
7552
7553 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7554 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7555 }
7556 }
7557
7558 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7559 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7560 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7561 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7562 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7563
7564 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7565 }
7566
7567 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7568 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7569
7570 return 0;
7571 }
7572
7573
7574 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7575 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7576
7577 int
7578 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7579 {
7580 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7581 return 1;
7582
7583 {
7584 XTextProperty text;
7585 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7586 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7587 text.format = 8;
7588 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7589 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7590 }
7591
7592 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7593 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7594 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7595 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7596
7597 return 0;
7598 }
7599 \f
7600 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7601
7602 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7603 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7604
7605 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7606 be called from a signal handler.
7607 */
7608
7609 struct x_error_message_stack {
7610 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7611 Display *dpy;
7612 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7613 };
7614 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7615
7616 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7617 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7618 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7619
7620 static void
7621 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7622 {
7623 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7624 x_error_message->string,
7625 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7626 }
7627
7628 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7629 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7630 operating on.
7631
7632 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7633 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7634 stored in *x_error_message.
7635
7636 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7637 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7638
7639 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7640
7641 void
7642 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7643 {
7644 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof *data);
7645
7646 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7647 XSync (dpy, False);
7648
7649 data->dpy = dpy;
7650 data->string[0] = 0;
7651 data->prev = x_error_message;
7652 x_error_message = data;
7653 }
7654
7655 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7656 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7657
7658 void
7659 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7660 {
7661 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7662
7663 BLOCK_INPUT;
7664
7665 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7666 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7667 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7668 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7669
7670 tmp = x_error_message;
7671 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7672 xfree (tmp);
7673 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7674 }
7675
7676 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7677 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7678 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7679
7680 void
7681 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7682 {
7683 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7684 XSync (dpy, False);
7685
7686 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7687 {
7688 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7689 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7690 x_uncatch_errors ();
7691 error (format, string);
7692 }
7693 }
7694
7695 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7696 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7697
7698 int
7699 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7700 {
7701 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7702 XSync (dpy, False);
7703
7704 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7705 }
7706
7707 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7708
7709 void
7710 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7711 {
7712 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7713 }
7714
7715 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7716 * idea. --lorentey */
7717 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7718
7719 void
7720 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7721 {
7722 while (x_error_message)
7723 x_uncatch_errors ();
7724 }
7725 #endif
7726
7727 #if 0
7728 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7729 x_trace_wire (void)
7730 {
7731 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7732 }
7733 #endif /* ! 0 */
7734
7735 \f
7736 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7737 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7738 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7739 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7740 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7741
7742 static void
7743 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7744 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7745 {
7746 #ifdef USG
7747 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7748 must reestablish each time */
7749 struct sigaction action;
7750 emacs_sigaction_init (&action, x_connection_signal);
7751 sigaction (signalnum, &action, 0);
7752 #endif /* USG */
7753 }
7754
7755 \f
7756 /************************************************************************
7757 Handling X errors
7758 ************************************************************************/
7759
7760 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7761
7762 static char *error_msg;
7763
7764 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7765 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7766
7767 static void
7768 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7769 {
7770 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7771 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7772 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7773
7774 error_msg = alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7775 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7776
7777 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7778 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7779
7780 if (dpyinfo)
7781 {
7782 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7783 frame on it. */
7784 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7785 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7786 }
7787
7788 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7789 that are on the dead display. */
7790 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7791 {
7792 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7793 minibuf_frame
7794 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7795 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7796 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7797 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7798 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7799 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7800 }
7801
7802 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7803 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7804 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7805 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7806 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7807 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7808 {
7809 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7810 trying to find a replacement. */
7811 kset_default_minibuffer_frame (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Qt);
7812 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7813 }
7814
7815 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7816 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7817 if (dpyinfo)
7818 {
7819 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7820 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7821 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7822 #ifdef USE_GTK
7823 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7824 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7825 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7826 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7827 shut_down_emacs (0, Qnil);
7828 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7829 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7830 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7831 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7832 error_msg);
7833 emacs_abort ();
7834 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7835
7836 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7837 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7838
7839 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7840 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7841 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7842 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7843 emacs_abort ();
7844
7845 {
7846 Lisp_Object tmp;
7847 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7848 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7849 }
7850 }
7851
7852 if (terminal_list == 0)
7853 {
7854 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7855 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7856 /* NOTREACHED */
7857 }
7858
7859 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7860 {
7861 sigset_t unblocked;
7862 sigemptyset (&unblocked);
7863 #ifdef USABLE_SIGIO
7864 sigaddset (&unblocked, SIGIO);
7865 #endif
7866 sigaddset (&unblocked, SIGALRM);
7867 pthread_sigmask (SIG_UNBLOCK, &unblocked, 0);
7868 }
7869 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7870
7871 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7872 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7873
7874 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7875 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7876
7877 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7878 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7879 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7880 error ("%s", error_msg);
7881 }
7882
7883 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7884 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7885 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7886
7887 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7888 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7889
7890 static int
7891 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7892 {
7893 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
7894 if (event->error_code == BadMatch
7895 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus
7896 && event->minor_code == 0)
7897 {
7898 return 0;
7899 }
7900 #endif
7901
7902 if (x_error_message)
7903 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7904 else
7905 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7906 return 0;
7907 }
7908
7909 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7910 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7911 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7912
7913 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7914
7915 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7916 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7917
7918 static void NO_INLINE
7919 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7920 {
7921 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7922
7923 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7924 or colors that are not defined. */
7925
7926 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7927 return;
7928
7929 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7930 original error handler. */
7931
7932 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7933 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7934 buf, event->request_code);
7935 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7936 }
7937
7938
7939 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7940 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7941 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7942
7943 static int
7944 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7945 {
7946 char buf[256];
7947
7948 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7949 DisplayString (display));
7950 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7951 return 0;
7952 }
7953 \f
7954 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7955
7956 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7957 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7958 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7959 FONT-OBJECT. */
7960
7961 Lisp_Object
7962 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7963 {
7964 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7965
7966 if (fontset < 0)
7967 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7968 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7969 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7970 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7971 do. */
7972 return font_object;
7973
7974 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7975 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7976 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7977 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7978 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7979
7980 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7981
7982 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7983 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7984 {
7985 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7986 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7987 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7988 }
7989 else
7990 {
7991 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7992 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7993 }
7994
7995 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7996 {
7997 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7998 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7999 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
8000 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8001 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
8002 }
8003
8004 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8005 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
8006 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
8007 {
8008 BLOCK_INPUT;
8009 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
8010 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8011 }
8012 #endif
8013
8014 return font_object;
8015 }
8016
8017 \f
8018 /***********************************************************************
8019 X Input Methods
8020 ***********************************************************************/
8021
8022 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8023
8024 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8025
8026 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
8027 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
8028 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
8029
8030 static void
8031 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8032 {
8033 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
8034 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8035
8036 BLOCK_INPUT;
8037
8038 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8039 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8040 {
8041 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8042 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8043 {
8044 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8045 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8046 }
8047 }
8048
8049 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8050 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8051 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8052 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8053 }
8054
8055 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8056
8057 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8058 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8059 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
8060 #endif
8061
8062 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8063 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8064
8065 static void
8066 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8067 {
8068 XIM xim;
8069
8070 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8071 if (use_xim)
8072 {
8073 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8074 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8075 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8076 emacs_class);
8077 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8078
8079 if (xim)
8080 {
8081 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8082 XIMCallback destroy;
8083 #endif
8084
8085 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8086 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8087
8088 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8089 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8090 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8091 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8092 #endif
8093 }
8094 }
8095
8096 else
8097 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8098 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8099 }
8100
8101
8102 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8103
8104 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8105 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8106 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8107 when the callback was registered. */
8108
8109 static void
8110 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8111 {
8112 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8113 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8114
8115 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8116 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8117 return;
8118
8119 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8120
8121 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8122 as they have no XIC. */
8123 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8124 {
8125 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8126
8127 BLOCK_INPUT;
8128 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8129 {
8130 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8131
8132 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8133 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8134 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8135 {
8136 create_frame_xic (f);
8137 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8138 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8139 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8140 {
8141 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8142 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8143 }
8144 }
8145 }
8146
8147 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8148 }
8149 }
8150
8151 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8152
8153
8154 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8155 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8156 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8157 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8158
8159 static void
8160 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8161 {
8162 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8163 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8164 if (use_xim)
8165 {
8166 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8167 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst);
8168 ptrdiff_t len;
8169
8170 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8171 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8172 len = strlen (resource_name);
8173 xim_inst->resource_name = xmalloc (len + 1);
8174 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8175 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8176 resource_name, emacs_class,
8177 xim_instantiate_callback,
8178 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8179 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8180 least, hence the configure test. */
8181 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8182 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8183 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8184 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8185 }
8186 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8187 }
8188
8189
8190 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8191
8192 static void
8193 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8194 {
8195 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8196 if (use_xim)
8197 {
8198 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8199 if (dpyinfo->display)
8200 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8201 NULL, emacs_class,
8202 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8203 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8204 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8205 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8206 if (dpyinfo->display)
8207 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8208 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8209 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8210 }
8211 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8212 }
8213
8214 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8215
8216
8217 \f
8218 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8219 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8220
8221 static void
8222 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8223 {
8224 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8225
8226 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8227 is already for the top-left corner. */
8228 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8229 return;
8230
8231 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8232 position that fits on the screen. */
8233 if (flags & XNegative)
8234 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8235 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8236
8237 {
8238 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8239
8240 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8241 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8242 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8243
8244 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8245 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8246 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8247 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8248 is right, though.
8249
8250 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8251 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8252
8253 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8254 #endif
8255
8256 if (flags & YNegative)
8257 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8258 - height + f->top_pos;
8259 }
8260
8261 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8262 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8263 so the flags should correspond. */
8264 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8265 }
8266
8267 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8268 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8269 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8270 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8271 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8272
8273 void
8274 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8275 {
8276 int modified_top, modified_left;
8277
8278 if (change_gravity > 0)
8279 {
8280 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8281 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8282
8283 f->top_pos = yoff;
8284 f->left_pos = xoff;
8285 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8286 if (xoff < 0)
8287 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8288 if (yoff < 0)
8289 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8290 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8291 }
8292 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8293
8294 BLOCK_INPUT;
8295 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8296
8297 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8298 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8299
8300 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8301 {
8302 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8303 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8304 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8305 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8306 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8307 }
8308
8309 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8310 modified_left, modified_top);
8311
8312 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8313 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8314 ? 1 : 0);
8315
8316 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8317 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8318 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8319 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8320 of the frame.
8321
8322 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8323 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8324 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8325
8326 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8327 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8328 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8329 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8330 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8331 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8332
8333 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8334 }
8335
8336 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8337 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8338 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8339 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8340 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8341
8342 static int
8343 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8344 {
8345 Atom actual_type;
8346 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8347 int i, rc, actual_format;
8348 Window wmcheck_window;
8349 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8350 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8351 long max_len = 65536;
8352 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8353 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8354 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8355
8356 BLOCK_INPUT;
8357
8358 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8359 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8360 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8361 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8362 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8363 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8364
8365 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8366 {
8367 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8368 x_uncatch_errors ();
8369 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8370 return 0;
8371 }
8372
8373 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8374 XFree (tmp_data);
8375
8376 /* Check if window exists. */
8377 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8378 x_sync (f);
8379 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8380 {
8381 x_uncatch_errors ();
8382 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8383 return 0;
8384 }
8385
8386 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8387 {
8388 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8389 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8390 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8391 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8392 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8393 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8394
8395 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8396 tmp_data = NULL;
8397 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8398 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8399 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8400 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8401 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8402
8403 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8404 {
8405 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8406 x_uncatch_errors ();
8407 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8408 return 0;
8409 }
8410
8411 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8412 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8413 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8414 }
8415
8416 rc = 0;
8417
8418 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8419 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8420
8421 x_uncatch_errors ();
8422 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8423
8424 return rc;
8425 }
8426
8427 static void
8428 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8429 {
8430 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8431
8432 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8433 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8434 make_number (32),
8435 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8436 Fcons
8437 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8438 Fcons
8439 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8440 value != 0
8441 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8442 : Qnil)));
8443 }
8444
8445 void
8446 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8447 {
8448 Lisp_Object frame;
8449 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8450
8451 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8452
8453 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8454 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8455 }
8456
8457 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8458 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8459 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
8460
8461 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
8462
8463 static int
8464 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8465 Window window,
8466 int *size_state,
8467 int *sticky)
8468 {
8469 Atom actual_type;
8470 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8471 int i, rc, actual_format, is_hidden = 0;
8472 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8473 long max_len = 65536;
8474 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8475 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8476 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8477
8478 *sticky = 0;
8479 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8480
8481 BLOCK_INPUT;
8482 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8483 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8484 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8485 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8486 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8487
8488 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8489 {
8490 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8491 x_uncatch_errors ();
8492 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8493 return ! f->iconified;
8494 }
8495
8496 x_uncatch_errors ();
8497
8498 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8499 {
8500 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8501 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
8502 {
8503 is_hidden = 1;
8504 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 1;
8505 }
8506 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8507 {
8508 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8509 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8510 else
8511 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8512 }
8513 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8514 {
8515 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8516 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8517 else
8518 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8519 }
8520 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8521 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8522 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8523 *sticky = 1;
8524 }
8525
8526 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8527 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8528 return ! is_hidden;
8529 }
8530
8531 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8532
8533 static int
8534 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8535 {
8536 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8537 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8538 int cur, dummy;
8539
8540 (void)get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8541
8542 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8543 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8544 if (!have_net_atom)
8545 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8546
8547 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8548 {
8549 Lisp_Object frame;
8550
8551 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8552
8553 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8554 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8555 are sent at once. */
8556 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8557 {
8558 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8559 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8560 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8561 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8562 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8563 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8564 break;
8565 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8566 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8567 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8568 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8569 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8570 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8571 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8572 break;
8573 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8574 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8575 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8576 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8577 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8578 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8579 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8580 break;
8581 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8582 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8583 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8584 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8585 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8586 break;
8587 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8588 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8589 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8590 else
8591 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8592 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8593 }
8594
8595 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8596
8597 }
8598
8599 return have_net_atom;
8600 }
8601
8602 static void
8603 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8604 {
8605 if (f->async_visible)
8606 {
8607 BLOCK_INPUT;
8608 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8609 x_sync (f);
8610 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8611 }
8612 }
8613
8614
8615 static int
8616 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8617 {
8618 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8619 Lisp_Object lval;
8620 int sticky = 0;
8621 int not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8622
8623 lval = Qnil;
8624 switch (value)
8625 {
8626 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8627 lval = Qfullwidth;
8628 break;
8629 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8630 lval = Qfullheight;
8631 break;
8632 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8633 lval = Qfullboth;
8634 break;
8635 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8636 lval = Qmaximized;
8637 break;
8638 }
8639
8640 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8641 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8642
8643 return not_hidden;
8644 }
8645
8646 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8647 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8648 static void
8649 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8650 {
8651 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8652 return;
8653
8654 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8655 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8656
8657 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8658 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8659 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8660
8661 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8662 {
8663 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8664 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8665
8666 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8667 {
8668 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8669 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8670 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8671 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8672 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8673 break;
8674 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8675 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8676 break;
8677 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8678 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8679 }
8680
8681 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8682 width, height);
8683 }
8684 }
8685
8686 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8687 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8688 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8689 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8690 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8691 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8692 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8693
8694 static void
8695 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8696 {
8697 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8698
8699 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8700 window manager window around the frame. */
8701
8702 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8703
8704 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8705 {
8706 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8707
8708 int adjusted_left;
8709 int adjusted_top;
8710
8711 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8712 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8713 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8714
8715 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8716
8717 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8718 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8719
8720 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8721 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8722
8723 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8724 }
8725 else
8726 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8727 frame's position. */
8728
8729 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8730 }
8731
8732
8733 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8734 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8735 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8736 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8737 of an exact comparison. */
8738
8739 static void
8740 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8741 {
8742 int count = 0;
8743
8744 while (count++ < 50)
8745 {
8746 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8747
8748 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8749 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8750 loop. */
8751
8752 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8753 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8754
8755 if (fuzzy)
8756 {
8757 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8758 pixels. */
8759
8760 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8761 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8762 return;
8763 }
8764 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8765 return;
8766 }
8767
8768 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8769 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8770
8771 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8772 }
8773
8774
8775 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8776 void
8777 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8778 {
8779 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8780
8781 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8782 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8783 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8784
8785 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8786 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8787
8788 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
8789 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8790 tmo = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
8791 tmo_at = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), tmo);
8792
8793 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8794 {
8795 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8796 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8797 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8798 BLOCK_INPUT;
8799 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8800
8801 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8802 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8803
8804 time_now = current_emacs_time ();
8805 if (EMACS_TIME_LT (tmo_at, time_now))
8806 break;
8807
8808 tmo = sub_emacs_time (tmo_at, time_now);
8809 if (pselect (fd + 1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo, NULL) == 0)
8810 break; /* Timeout */
8811 }
8812 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8813 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8814 }
8815
8816
8817 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8818 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8819 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8820 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8821
8822 static void
8823 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8824 {
8825 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8826
8827 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8828 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8829 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8830 ? 0
8831 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8832
8833 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8834
8835 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8836 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8837 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8838 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8839
8840 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8841 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8842 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8843 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8844
8845
8846 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8847 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8848 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8849 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8850 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8851
8852 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8853 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8854 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8855 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8856
8857 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8858 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8859 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8860 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8861 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8862
8863 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8864 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8865
8866 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8867 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8868 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8869 if (f->async_visible)
8870 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8871 else
8872 {
8873 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8874 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8875 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8876 x_sync (f);
8877 }
8878 }
8879
8880
8881 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8882 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8883 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8884 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8885
8886 void
8887 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8888 {
8889 BLOCK_INPUT;
8890
8891 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8892 {
8893 int r, c;
8894
8895 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8896 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8897 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8898 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8899 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8900 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8901 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8902 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8903 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8904 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8905 is however. */
8906 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8907 #endif
8908 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8909 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8910 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8911 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8912 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8913 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8914 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8915 }
8916
8917 #ifdef USE_GTK
8918 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8919 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8920 else
8921 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8922 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8923
8924 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8925
8926 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8927
8928 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8929 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8930
8931 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8932 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8933 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8934 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8935 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8936
8937 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8938 }
8939 \f
8940 /* Mouse warping. */
8941
8942 void
8943 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8944 {
8945 int pix_x, pix_y;
8946
8947 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8948 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8949
8950 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8951 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8952
8953 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8954 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8955
8956 BLOCK_INPUT;
8957
8958 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8959 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8960 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8961 }
8962
8963 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8964
8965 void
8966 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8967 {
8968 BLOCK_INPUT;
8969
8970 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8971 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8972 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8973 }
8974 \f
8975 /* Raise frame F. */
8976
8977 void
8978 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8979 {
8980 BLOCK_INPUT;
8981 if (f->async_visible)
8982 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8983
8984 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8985 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8986 }
8987
8988 /* Lower frame F. */
8989
8990 static void
8991 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8992 {
8993 if (f->async_visible)
8994 {
8995 BLOCK_INPUT;
8996 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8997 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8998 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8999 }
9000 }
9001
9002 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
9003
9004 void
9005 xembed_request_focus (FRAME_PTR f)
9006 {
9007 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
9008 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
9009 if (f->async_visible)
9010 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
9011 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
9012 }
9013
9014 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
9015
9016 void
9017 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
9018 {
9019 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
9020 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
9021
9022 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9023 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
9024 {
9025 Lisp_Object frame;
9026 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9027 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
9028 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
9029 make_number (32),
9030 Fcons (make_number (1),
9031 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
9032 Qnil)));
9033 }
9034 }
9035
9036 static void
9037 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
9038 {
9039 if (raise_flag)
9040 x_raise_frame (f);
9041 else
9042 x_lower_frame (f);
9043 }
9044 \f
9045 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9046
9047 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
9048
9049 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9050
9051 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
9052
9053 static void
9054 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
9055 {
9056 unsigned long data[2];
9057 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9058
9059 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
9060 data[1] = flags;
9061
9062 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9063 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
9064 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9065 }
9066 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
9067
9068 static void
9069 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
9070 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9071 {
9072 XEvent event;
9073
9074 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9075 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9076 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9077 event.xclient.format = 32;
9078 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9079 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9080 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9081 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9082 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9083
9084 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9085 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9086 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9087 }
9088 \f
9089 /* Change of visibility. */
9090
9091 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9092 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9093 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9094 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9095 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9096 finishes with it. */
9097
9098 void
9099 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9100 {
9101 Lisp_Object type;
9102 int original_top, original_left;
9103 int retry_count = 2;
9104
9105 retry:
9106
9107 BLOCK_INPUT;
9108
9109 type = x_icon_type (f);
9110 if (!NILP (type))
9111 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9112
9113 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9114 {
9115 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9116 call x_set_offset a second time
9117 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9118 before the window gets really visible. */
9119 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9120 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9121 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9122 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9123
9124 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9125
9126 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9127 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9128 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9129 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9130 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9131 else
9132 {
9133 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9134 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9135 }
9136 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9137 #ifdef USE_GTK
9138 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9139 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9140 #else
9141 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9142 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9143 else
9144 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9145 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9146 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9147 }
9148
9149 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9150
9151 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9152 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9153 so that incoming events are handled. */
9154 {
9155 Lisp_Object frame;
9156 int count;
9157 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9158 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9159 will set it when they are handled. */
9160 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9161
9162 original_left = f->left_pos;
9163 original_top = f->top_pos;
9164
9165 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9166 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9167
9168 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9169
9170 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9171 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9172 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9173 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9174
9175 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9176 because the window manager may choose the position
9177 and we don't want to override it. */
9178
9179 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9180 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9181 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9182 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9183 && previously_visible)
9184 {
9185 Drawable rootw;
9186 int x, y;
9187 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9188
9189 BLOCK_INPUT;
9190
9191 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9192 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9193 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9194 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9195 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9196 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9197 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9198 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9199 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9200
9201 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9202 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9203 original_left, original_top);
9204
9205 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9206 }
9207
9208 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9209
9210 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9211 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9212 MapNotify at all.. */
9213 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9214 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9215 {
9216 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9217 x_sync (f);
9218
9219 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9220 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9221 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9222 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9223 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9224 probably a bug. */
9225 if (input_polling_used ())
9226 {
9227 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9228 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9229 handler reset it. */
9230 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9231 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9232 poll_for_input_1 ();
9233 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9234 }
9235
9236 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9237 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9238 }
9239
9240 /* 2000-09-28: In
9241
9242 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9243 (iconify-frame f)
9244 (raise-frame f))
9245
9246 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9247 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9248 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9249 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9250
9251 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9252 goto retry;
9253 }
9254 }
9255
9256 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9257
9258 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9259
9260 void
9261 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9262 {
9263 Window window;
9264
9265 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9266 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9267
9268 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9269 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9270 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9271
9272 BLOCK_INPUT;
9273
9274 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9275 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9276 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9277 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9278 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9279 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9280
9281 #ifdef USE_GTK
9282 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9283 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9284 else
9285 #else
9286 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9287 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9288 else
9289 #endif
9290 {
9291
9292 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9293 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9294 {
9295 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9296 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9297 }
9298 }
9299
9300 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9301 just by the event that we get from the server.
9302 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9303 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9304 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9305 f->visible = 0;
9306 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9307 f->async_visible = 0;
9308 f->async_iconified = 0;
9309
9310 x_sync (f);
9311
9312 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9313 }
9314
9315 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9316
9317 void
9318 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9319 {
9320 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9321 int result;
9322 #endif
9323 Lisp_Object type;
9324
9325 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9326 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9327 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9328
9329 if (f->async_iconified)
9330 return;
9331
9332 BLOCK_INPUT;
9333
9334 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9335
9336 type = x_icon_type (f);
9337 if (!NILP (type))
9338 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9339
9340 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9341 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9342 {
9343 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9344 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9345
9346 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9347 f->iconified = 1;
9348 f->visible = 1;
9349 f->async_iconified = 1;
9350 f->async_visible = 0;
9351 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9352 return;
9353 }
9354 #endif
9355
9356 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9357
9358 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9359 {
9360 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9361 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9362 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9363 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9364 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9365 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9366 so we have to record it here. */
9367 f->iconified = 1;
9368 f->visible = 1;
9369 f->async_iconified = 1;
9370 f->async_visible = 0;
9371 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9372 return;
9373 }
9374
9375 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9376 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9377 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9378 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9379
9380 if (!result)
9381 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9382
9383 f->async_iconified = 1;
9384 f->async_visible = 0;
9385
9386
9387 BLOCK_INPUT;
9388 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9389 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9390 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9391
9392 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9393 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9394 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9395 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9396 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9397 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9398
9399 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9400 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9401
9402 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9403 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9404 {
9405 XEvent msg;
9406
9407 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9408 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9409 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9410 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9411 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9412
9413 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9414 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9415 False,
9416 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9417 &msg))
9418 {
9419 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9420 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9421 }
9422 }
9423
9424 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9425 IconicState. */
9426 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9427
9428 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9429 {
9430 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9431 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9432 }
9433
9434 f->async_iconified = 1;
9435 f->async_visible = 0;
9436
9437 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9438 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9439 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9440 }
9441
9442 \f
9443 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9444
9445 void
9446 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9447 {
9448 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9449 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9450 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9451 Lisp_Object bar;
9452 struct scroll_bar *b;
9453 #endif
9454
9455 BLOCK_INPUT;
9456
9457 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9458 commands to the X server. */
9459 if (dpyinfo->display)
9460 {
9461 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9462 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9463 face. */
9464 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9465 free_frame_faces (f);
9466
9467 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9468 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9469
9470 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9471 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9472 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9473 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9474 toolkit scroll bars. */
9475 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9476 {
9477 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9478 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9479 }
9480 #endif
9481
9482 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9483 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9484 free_frame_xic (f);
9485 #endif
9486
9487 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9488 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9489 {
9490 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9491 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9492 }
9493 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9494 we are using a toolkit. */
9495 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9496 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9497
9498 free_frame_menubar (f);
9499 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9500
9501 #ifdef USE_GTK
9502 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9503 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9504
9505 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9506 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9507 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9508
9509 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9510 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9511 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9512 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9513 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9514 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9515
9516 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9517 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9518 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9519 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9520 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9521 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9522 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9523 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9524 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9525 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9526 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9527 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9528 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9529 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9530 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9531
9532 x_free_gcs (f);
9533 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9534 }
9535
9536 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9537 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9538 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9539
9540 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9541 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9542 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9543 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9544 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9545 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9546
9547 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9548 {
9549 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9550 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9551 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9552 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9553 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9554 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9555 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9556 }
9557
9558 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9559 }
9560
9561
9562 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9563
9564 static void
9565 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9566 {
9567 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9568
9569 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9570 commands to the X server. */
9571 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9572 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9573
9574 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9575 }
9576
9577 \f
9578 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9579
9580 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9581 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9582 that the window now has.
9583 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9584 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9585 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9586
9587 #ifndef USE_GTK
9588 void
9589 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9590 {
9591 XSizeHints size_hints;
9592 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9593
9594 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9595 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9596 {
9597 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
9598 return;
9599 }
9600 #endif
9601
9602 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9603 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9604
9605 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9606 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9607
9608 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9609 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9610
9611 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9612 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9613 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9614 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9615 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9616 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9617
9618 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9619 {
9620 int base_width, base_height;
9621 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9622
9623 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9624 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9625
9626 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9627
9628 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9629 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9630 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9631 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9632 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9633
9634 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9635 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9636 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9637
9638 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9639 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9640 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9641 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9642 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9643 }
9644
9645 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9646 if (flags)
9647 {
9648 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9649 goto no_read;
9650 }
9651
9652 {
9653 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9654 long supplied_return;
9655 int value;
9656
9657 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9658 &supplied_return);
9659
9660 if (flags)
9661 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9662 else
9663 {
9664 if (value == 0)
9665 hints.flags = 0;
9666 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9667 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9668 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9669 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9670 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9671 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9672 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9673 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9674 }
9675 }
9676
9677 no_read:
9678
9679 #ifdef PWinGravity
9680 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9681 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9682
9683 if (user_position)
9684 {
9685 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9686 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9687 }
9688 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9689
9690 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9691 }
9692 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9693
9694 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9695
9696 static void
9697 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9698 {
9699 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9700 Arg al[1];
9701
9702 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9703 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9704 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9705 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9706
9707 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9708 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9709
9710 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9711 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9712 }
9713
9714 static void
9715 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9716 {
9717 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9718
9719 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9720 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9721 #endif
9722
9723 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9724 {
9725 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9726 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9727 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9728 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9729 }
9730 else
9731 {
9732 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9733 pixmap. */
9734 return;
9735 }
9736
9737
9738 #ifdef USE_GTK
9739 {
9740 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9741 return;
9742 }
9743
9744 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9745
9746 {
9747 Arg al[1];
9748 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9749 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9750 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9751 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9752 }
9753
9754 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9755
9756 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9757 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9758
9759 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9760 }
9761
9762 void
9763 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9764 {
9765 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9766
9767 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9768 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9769 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9770
9771 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9772 }
9773
9774 \f
9775 /***********************************************************************
9776 Fonts
9777 ***********************************************************************/
9778
9779 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
9780
9781 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9782 font table. */
9783
9784 static void
9785 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9786 {
9787 eassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9788 if (font->driver->check)
9789 eassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9790 }
9791
9792 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
9793
9794 \f
9795 /***********************************************************************
9796 Initialization
9797 ***********************************************************************/
9798
9799 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9800 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9801 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9802 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9803
9804 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9805 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9806 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9807
9808 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9809 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9810 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9811 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9812 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9813 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9814 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9815 };
9816
9817 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9818
9819 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9820
9821 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9822
9823 static int x_initialized;
9824
9825 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9826 the screen number from the server number. */
9827 static int
9828 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9829 {
9830 int seen_colon = 0;
9831 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9832 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9833 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9834
9835 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9836 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9837 length_until_period++;
9838
9839 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9840 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9841 name1 += 4;
9842 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9843 name2 += 4;
9844 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9845 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9846 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9847 name1 += system_name_length;
9848 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9849 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9850 name2 += system_name_length;
9851 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9852 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9853 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9854 name1 += length_until_period;
9855 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9856 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9857 name2 += length_until_period;
9858
9859 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9860 {
9861 if (*name1 == ':')
9862 seen_colon = 1;
9863 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9864 return 1;
9865 }
9866 return (seen_colon
9867 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9868 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9869 }
9870
9871 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9872 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9873 to 5. */
9874 static void
9875 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9876 {
9877 int nr = 0;
9878 int off = 0;
9879
9880 while (!(mask & 1))
9881 {
9882 off++;
9883 mask >>= 1;
9884 }
9885
9886 while (mask & 1)
9887 {
9888 nr++;
9889 mask >>= 1;
9890 }
9891
9892 *offset = off;
9893 *bits = nr;
9894 }
9895
9896 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9897 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9898
9899 int
9900 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9901 {
9902 int dpy_ok = 1;
9903 Display *dpy;
9904
9905 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9906 if (dpy)
9907 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9908 else
9909 dpy_ok = 0;
9910 return dpy_ok;
9911 }
9912
9913 #ifdef USE_GTK
9914 static void
9915 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9916 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9917 {
9918 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9919 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9920 }
9921 #endif
9922
9923 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9924 the structure that describes the open display.
9925 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9926
9927 struct x_display_info *
9928 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9929 {
9930 int connection;
9931 Display *dpy;
9932 struct terminal *terminal;
9933 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9934 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9935 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9936 ptrdiff_t lim;
9937
9938 BLOCK_INPUT;
9939
9940 if (!x_initialized)
9941 {
9942 x_initialize ();
9943 ++x_initialized;
9944 }
9945
9946 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9947 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9948
9949 #ifdef USE_GTK
9950 {
9951 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9952 int argc;
9953 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9954 char **argv2 = argv;
9955 guint id;
9956
9957 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9958 {
9959 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9960 }
9961 else
9962 {
9963 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9964 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9965
9966 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9967 argv[argc] = 0;
9968
9969 argc = 0;
9970 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9971
9972 if (! NILP (display_name))
9973 {
9974 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9975 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9976 }
9977
9978 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9979 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9980
9981 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9982
9983 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9984 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9985 {
9986 static char fix_events[] = "GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1";
9987 putenv (fix_events);
9988 }
9989
9990 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9991 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9992 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9993 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9994
9995 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
9996 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
9997 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9998
9999 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10000 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
10001
10002 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10003 fixup_locale ();
10004 xg_initialize ();
10005
10006 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
10007
10008 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
10009 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10010 {
10011 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10012 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10013
10014 s = build_string (file);
10015 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10016
10017 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10018 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
10019 }
10020 #endif
10021
10022 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10023 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10024 }
10025 }
10026 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10027 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10028 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10029 errors with X11R5:
10030 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10031 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10032 So let's not use it until R6. */
10033 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10034 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10035 #endif
10036
10037 {
10038 int argc = 0;
10039 char *argv[3];
10040
10041 argv[0] = "";
10042 argc = 1;
10043 if (xrm_option)
10044 {
10045 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10046 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10047 }
10048 turn_on_atimers (0);
10049 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
10050 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10051 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10052 &argc, argv);
10053 turn_on_atimers (1);
10054
10055 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10056 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10057 fixup_locale ();
10058 #endif
10059 }
10060
10061 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10062 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10063 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
10064 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10065 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10066
10067 /* Detect failure. */
10068 if (dpy == 0)
10069 {
10070 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10071 return 0;
10072 }
10073
10074 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10075
10076 dpyinfo = xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo);
10077 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
10078
10079 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10080
10081 {
10082 struct x_display_info *share;
10083 Lisp_Object tail;
10084
10085 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10086 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10087 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10088 SSDATA (display_name)))
10089 break;
10090 if (share)
10091 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10092 else
10093 {
10094 terminal->kboard = xmalloc (sizeof *terminal->kboard);
10095 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10096 kset_window_system (terminal->kboard, Qx);
10097
10098 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10099 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10100 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10101 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10102 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10103
10104 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10105 {
10106 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10107
10108 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10109 list of terminals. */
10110 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10111 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10112 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10113 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10114
10115 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10116 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10117 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10118 kset_system_key_alist
10119 (terminal->kboard,
10120 call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10121 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string));
10122 BLOCK_INPUT;
10123 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10124 terminal_list = terminal;
10125 UNGCPRO;
10126 }
10127
10128 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10129 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10130 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10131 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10132 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10133 }
10134 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10135 }
10136
10137 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10138 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10139 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10140
10141 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10142 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10143 x_display_name_list);
10144 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10145
10146 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10147
10148 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10149 terminal->name = xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10150 memcpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10151 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10152
10153 #if 0
10154 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10155 #endif /* ! 0 */
10156
10157 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10158 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10159 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10160 dpyinfo->x_id_name = xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10161 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name) + 2);
10162 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10163 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10164
10165 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10166 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10167
10168 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10169 #ifdef USE_GTK
10170 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10171 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10172 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10173
10174 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10175 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10176
10177 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10178 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10179 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10180 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10181 #else
10182 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10183 #endif
10184 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10185 all versions. */
10186 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10187
10188 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10189 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10190 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10191 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10192 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10193 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10194 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10195 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10196 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10197 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10198 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10199 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10200 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10201 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10202 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10203 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10204 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10205 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10206 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10207 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10208 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10209 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10210 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10211 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10212 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10213 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10214 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10215 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10216
10217 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10218 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10219 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10220
10221 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10222 {
10223 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10224 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10225 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10226 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10227 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10228 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10229 }
10230
10231 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10232 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10233 {
10234 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10235 {
10236 Lisp_Object value;
10237 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10238 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10239 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10240 Qnil, Qnil);
10241 if (STRINGP (value)
10242 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10243 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10244 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10245 }
10246 }
10247 else
10248 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10249 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10250
10251 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10252 {
10253 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10254 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10255 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10256 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10257 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10258 for example). */
10259 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10260 double d;
10261 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10262 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10263 }
10264 #endif
10265
10266 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10267 {
10268 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10269 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10270 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10271 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10272 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10273 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10274 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10275 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10276 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10277 }
10278
10279 {
10280 const struct
10281 {
10282 const char *name;
10283 Atom *atom;
10284 } atom_refs[] = {
10285 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10286 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10287 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10288 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10289 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10290 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10291 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10292 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10293 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10294 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10295 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10296 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10297 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10298 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10299 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10300 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10301 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10302 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10303 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10304 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10305 { "ATOM", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM },
10306 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10307 { "CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER },
10308 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10309 /* For properties of font. */
10310 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10311 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10312 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10313 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10314 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10315 /* Ghostscript support. */
10316 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10317 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10318 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10319 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10320 /* EWMH */
10321 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10322 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10323 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10324 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10325 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10326 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10327 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10328 { "_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden },
10329 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10330 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10331 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10332 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10333 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10334 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10335 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10336 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10337 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10338 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10339 /* Session management */
10340 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10341 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10342 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10343 };
10344
10345 int i;
10346 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10347 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10348 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10349 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atoms_return);
10350 char **atom_names = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atom_names);
10351 static char const xsettings_fmt[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
10352 char xsettings_atom_name[sizeof xsettings_fmt - 2
10353 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
10354
10355 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10356 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10357
10358 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10359 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name, xsettings_fmt,
10360 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10361 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10362
10363 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10364 False, atoms_return);
10365
10366 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10367 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10368
10369 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10370 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10371
10372 xfree (atom_names);
10373 xfree (atoms_return);
10374 }
10375
10376 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10377 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10378 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms
10379 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10380
10381 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10382 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10383 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10384
10385 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10386 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10387 dpyinfo->gray
10388 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10389 gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height,
10390 1, 0, 1);
10391
10392 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10393 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10394 #endif
10395
10396 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10397
10398 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10399 if (connection != 0)
10400 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10401
10402 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10403 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10404 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10405
10406 if (interrupt_input)
10407 init_sigio (connection);
10408
10409 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10410 {
10411 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10412 Font font;
10413
10414 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10415 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10416 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10417 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10418 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10419 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10420 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10421 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10422 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10423 emacs_abort ();
10424 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10425 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10426 x_uncatch_errors ();
10427 }
10428 #endif
10429
10430 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10431 for debugging X code. */
10432 {
10433 Lisp_Object value;
10434 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10435 build_string ("synchronous"),
10436 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10437 Qnil, Qnil);
10438 if (STRINGP (value)
10439 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10440 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10441 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10442 }
10443
10444 {
10445 Lisp_Object value;
10446 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10447 build_string ("useXIM"),
10448 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10449 Qnil, Qnil);
10450 #ifdef USE_XIM
10451 if (STRINGP (value)
10452 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10453 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10454 use_xim = 0;
10455 #else
10456 if (STRINGP (value)
10457 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10458 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10459 use_xim = 1;
10460 #endif
10461 }
10462
10463 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10464 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10465 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10466 tty. */
10467 if (terminal->id == 1)
10468 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10469 #endif
10470
10471 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10472
10473 return dpyinfo;
10474 }
10475 \f
10476 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10477 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10478
10479 static void
10480 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10481 {
10482 struct terminal *t;
10483
10484 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10485 X display. */
10486 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10487 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10488 {
10489 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10490 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10491 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10492 x_session_close ();
10493 #endif
10494 delete_terminal (t);
10495 break;
10496 }
10497
10498 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10499
10500 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10501 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10502 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10503 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10504 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10505 else
10506 {
10507 Lisp_Object tail;
10508
10509 tail = x_display_name_list;
10510 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10511 {
10512 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10513 {
10514 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10515 break;
10516 }
10517 tail = XCDR (tail);
10518 }
10519 }
10520
10521 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10522 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10523
10524 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10525 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10526 else
10527 {
10528 struct x_display_info *tail;
10529
10530 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10531 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10532 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10533 }
10534
10535 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10536 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10537 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10538 xfree (dpyinfo);
10539 }
10540
10541 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10542
10543 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10544 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10545 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10546 that slows us down. */
10547
10548 static void
10549 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10550 {
10551 BLOCK_INPUT;
10552 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10553 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10554 {
10555 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10556 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10557 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10558 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10559 }
10560 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10561 }
10562
10563 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10564 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10565 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10566 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10567 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10568 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10569 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10570
10571 void
10572 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10573 {
10574 BLOCK_INPUT;
10575 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10576 {
10577 EMACS_TIME interval = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
10578 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10579 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10580 }
10581 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10582 }
10583
10584 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10585
10586 \f
10587 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10588
10589 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10590 {
10591 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10592 x_produce_glyphs,
10593 x_write_glyphs,
10594 x_insert_glyphs,
10595 x_clear_end_of_line,
10596 x_scroll_run,
10597 x_after_update_window_line,
10598 x_update_window_begin,
10599 x_update_window_end,
10600 x_cursor_to,
10601 x_flush,
10602 #ifdef XFlush
10603 x_flush,
10604 #else
10605 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10606 #endif
10607 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10608 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10609 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10610 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10611 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10612 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10613 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10614 x_draw_glyph_string,
10615 x_define_frame_cursor,
10616 x_clear_frame_area,
10617 x_draw_window_cursor,
10618 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10619 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10620 };
10621
10622
10623 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10624 void
10625 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10626 {
10627 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10628
10629 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10630 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10631 if (!terminal->name)
10632 return;
10633
10634 BLOCK_INPUT;
10635 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10636 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10637 X display. */
10638 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10639 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10640 #endif
10641
10642 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10643 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10644 if (dpyinfo->display)
10645 {
10646 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10647 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10648
10649 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10650 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10651 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10652 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10653
10654 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10655 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10656 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10657 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10658 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10659 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10660 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10661 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10662 leaks in other situations. */
10663 #if 0
10664 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10665 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10666 #else
10667 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10668 #endif
10669 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10670 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10671 closing all the displays. */
10672 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10673 #endif
10674
10675 #ifdef USE_GTK
10676 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10677 #else
10678 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10679 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10680 #else
10681 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10682 #endif
10683 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10684 }
10685
10686 /* Mark as dead. */
10687 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10688 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10689 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10690 }
10691
10692 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10693 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10694
10695 static struct terminal *
10696 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10697 {
10698 struct terminal *terminal;
10699
10700 terminal = create_terminal ();
10701
10702 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10703 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10704 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10705
10706 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10707
10708 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10709 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10710 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10711 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10712 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10713 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10714 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10715 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10716 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10717 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10718 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10719 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10720 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10721 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10722 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10723 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10724 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10725 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10726 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10727 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10728
10729 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10730 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10731
10732 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10733 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10734 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10735 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10736 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10737 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10738 off the bottom. */
10739
10740 return terminal;
10741 }
10742
10743 void
10744 x_initialize (void)
10745 {
10746 struct sigaction action;
10747
10748 baud_rate = 19200;
10749
10750 x_noop_count = 0;
10751 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10752 any_help_event_p = 0;
10753 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10754
10755 #ifdef USE_GTK
10756 current_count = -1;
10757 #endif
10758
10759 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10760 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10761
10762 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10763 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10764
10765 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10766
10767 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10768 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10769 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10770 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10771 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10772 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10773 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10774
10775 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10776 #endif
10777
10778 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10779 #ifndef USE_GTK
10780 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10781 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10782 #endif
10783 #endif
10784
10785 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10786 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10787 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10788
10789 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10790 original error handler. */
10791 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10792 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10793
10794 emacs_sigaction_init (&action, x_connection_signal);
10795 sigaction (SIGPIPE, &action, 0);
10796 }
10797
10798
10799 void
10800 syms_of_xterm (void)
10801 {
10802 x_error_message = NULL;
10803
10804 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10805 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10806
10807 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10808 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10809
10810 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10811 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10812
10813 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10814 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10815
10816 #ifdef USE_GTK
10817 xg_default_icon_file = build_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10818 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10819
10820 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10821 #endif
10822
10823 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10824 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10825 doc: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10826 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10827 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10828 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10829 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10830 sizes. */);
10831 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10832
10833 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10834 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10835 doc: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10836 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10837 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10838 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10839 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10840
10841 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10842 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10843 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10844 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10845 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10846 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10847 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10848 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10849 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10850
10851 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10852 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10853 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10854 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10855 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10856 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
10857 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10858 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10859 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10860 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10861 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10862 #elif USE_GTK
10863 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10864 #else
10865 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10866 #endif
10867 #else
10868 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10869 #endif
10870
10871 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10872 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10873
10874 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10875 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10876 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10877 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10878 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10879 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10880 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10881 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10882 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10883
10884 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10885 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10886 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10887 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10888 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10889 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10890
10891 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10892 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10893 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10894 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10895 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10896 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10897
10898 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10899 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10900 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10901 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10902 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10903 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10904
10905 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10906 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10907 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10908 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10909 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10910 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10911
10912 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10913 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10914 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10915 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10916 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10917 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10918 }
10919
10920 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */